2cba45ecd112702001bd5d1bd13310c0fd9d57fb
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} init
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @section Interface Drivers
2371
2372 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2373 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2374 available at run time.
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2377 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2378 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2379 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2382 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2383 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2384 @end deffn
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2387 Displays status of RTCK option.
2388 Optionally sets that option first.
2389 @end deffn
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2393 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2394 This has one driver-specific command:
2395
2396 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2397 Logs some status
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2402 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2403 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2404 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2405 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2406 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2410 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2411 or v2 (USB bulk).
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2428 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2429
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2432 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2433 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2434 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2435 @end itemize
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2439 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2440 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2441 interface string or for user class interface.
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2445 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2446 @end deffn
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2450 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2454 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2458 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2459 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2460
2461 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2462 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2463
2464 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2465 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2466
2467 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2468 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2469 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2470 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2471 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2472 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2473
2474 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2475 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2476 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2477 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2478 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2479
2480 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2481 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2482 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2483 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2484
2485 @itemize @minus
2486 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2487 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2488 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2489 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2491 switching data and direction as necessary
2492 @end itemize
2493
2494 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2495 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2498 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2499 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2500 @example
2501 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2502 @end example
2503 @end deffn
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2506 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2507 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2508 during device selection.
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2512 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2513 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2514 is connected to the host.
2515 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2516 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2517 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2521 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2522 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2523
2524 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2525 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2526 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2527 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2528 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2529
2530 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2534 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2535 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2536 @end deffn
2537
2538 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2539 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2540 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2541 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2542 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2543 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2544 and initially asserted reset signals.
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2548 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2549 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2550 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2551 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2552 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2553 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2554 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2555 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2556 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2557 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2558
2559 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2560 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2561 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2562 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2563 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2564 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2565
2566 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2567 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2568 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2569 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2570 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2571 are always driven by the FTDI.
2572
2573 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2574 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2575 @var{name}.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2579 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2580 @itemize @minus
2581 @item @option{0}, drive low
2582 @item @option{1}, drive high
2583 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2584 @end itemize
2585 @end deffn
2586
2587 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2588 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2592 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2593
2594 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2595 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2596 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2597 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2598 @itemize @minus
2599 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2600 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2601 @end itemize
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2605 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2606
2607 @end deffn
2608
2609 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2610 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2611 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2612 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2613
2614 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2615 @itemize @minus
2616 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2617 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2618 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2619 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2620 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2621 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2622 @end itemize
2623
2624 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2625 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2626 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2627 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2628 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2629 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2630 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2631 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2632
2633 FT232R
2634 @itemize @minus
2635 @item bit 7 - RI
2636 @item bit 6 - DCD
2637 @item bit 5 - DSR
2638 @item bit 4 - DTR
2639 @item bit 3 - CTS
2640 @item bit 2 - RTS
2641 @item bit 1 - RXD
2642 @item bit 0 - TXD
2643 @end itemize
2644
2645 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2646 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2649 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2650 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2651 @end deffn
2652
2653 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2654 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2655 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2656 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2660 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2661 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2665 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2666 @end deffn
2667
2668 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2669 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2670 @end deffn
2671
2672 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2673 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2677 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2681 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2682 @end deffn
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2685 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2689 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2690 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2691 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2692 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2693 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2694 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2695 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2696 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2697 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2703 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2704 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2705 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2706
2707 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2708 processors which are being simulated.
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2711 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2712 sockets instead of TCP.
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2716 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2717 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2721 something like:
2722
2723 @example
2724 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2725 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2726 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2727 @end example
2728
2729 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2730 named mysocket:
2731
2732 @example
2733 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2734 remote_bitbang_port 0
2735 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2736 @end example
2737 @end deffn
2738
2739 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2740 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2741 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2742 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2743
2744 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2745 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2746 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2747 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2748 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2749 @end deffn
2750
2751 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2752 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2753 default values are used.
2754 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2755 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2756 @example
2757 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2758 @end example
2759 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2760 @example
2761 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2762 @end example
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2766 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2767 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2768 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2769 target board.
2770
2771 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2772 @example
2773 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2774 reset_config srst_only
2775 @end example
2776 @end deffn
2777
2778 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2779 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2780 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2781 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2782 @end deffn
2783
2784 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2785 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2786 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2787 @end deffn
2788
2789 @end deffn
2790
2791 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2792 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2793 This has one driver-specific command:
2794
2795 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2796 Display either the address of the I/O port
2797 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2798 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2799 This is a write-once setting.
2800 @end deffn
2801 @end deffn
2802
2803 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2804 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2805 transports.
2806
2807 @quotation Compatibility Note
2808 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2809 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2810 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2811 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2812 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2813 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2814 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2815 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2816 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2817 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2818 @end quotation
2819
2820 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2821 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2822 states.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2825 Display free device internal memory.
2826 @end deffn
2827 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2828 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2829 command version.
2830 @end deffn
2831 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2832 Display the device configuration.
2833 @end deffn
2834 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2835 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2836 power state.
2837 @end deffn
2838 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2839 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2840 @end deffn
2841 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2842 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2843 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2844 IP configuration.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2847 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2848 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2851 Reset the current configuration.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2854 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2857 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2858 pairs.
2859
2860 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2861 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2862 @example
2863 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2864 @end example
2865 @end deffn
2866 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2867 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2868 pairs.
2869
2870 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2871 @example
2872 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2873 77a90000
2874 @end example
2875 @end deffn
2876 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2877 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2878 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2879 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2880 the serial number instead, if possible.
2881
2882 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2883 @end deffn
2884 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2885 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2886 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2887
2888 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2889 @end deffn
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2893 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2894 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2895 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2896 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2897 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2898 configuration script.
2899
2900 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2901 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2902 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2903 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2904 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2905
2906 Known limitations:
2907 @itemize @bullet
2908 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2909 and 2.7 MHz.
2910 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2911 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2912 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2913 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2914 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2915 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2916 communications with the target.
2917 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2918 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2919 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2920 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2921 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2922 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2923 @end itemize
2924
2925 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2926 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2927 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2928 @end deffn
2929
2930 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2931 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2932 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2933 @end deffn
2934
2935 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2936 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2937 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2938 target as a side-effect.
2939 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2940 @end deffn
2941
2942 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2943 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2944 version, and target voltage.
2945 @end deffn
2946 @end deffn
2947
2948 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2949 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2950 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2951 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2952 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2953
2954 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2955 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2956 This is a write-once setting.
2957 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2958
2959 @itemize @minus
2960 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2961 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2962 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2963 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2964 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2965 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2966 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2967 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2968 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2969 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2970 some versions of
2971 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2972 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2973 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2974 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2975 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2976 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2977 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2978 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2979 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2980 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2981 @end itemize
2982 @end deffn
2983
2984 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2985 Display either the address of the I/O port
2986 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2987 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2988 This is a write-once setting.
2989
2990 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2991 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2992 you may encounter a problem.
2993 @end deffn
2994
2995 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2996 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2997 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2998 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2999 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3000 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3001
3002 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3003 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3004 @quotation Tip
3005 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3006 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3007 @example
3008 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3009 > adapter speed 500
3010 @end example
3011 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3012 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3013 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3014 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3015 large set of samples.
3016 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3017 @example
3018 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3019 @end example
3020 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3021 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3022
3023 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3024 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3025 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3026 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3027 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3028 be conservative.
3029 @end quotation
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3033 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3034 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3035 @end deffn
3036
3037 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3038 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3039
3040 @example
3041 adapter driver parport
3042 parport_port 0x278
3043 parport_cable wiggler
3044 @end example
3045 @end deffn
3046
3047 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3048 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3049 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3050 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3051 @end deffn
3052 @end deffn
3053
3054 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3055 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3059 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3060 @end deffn
3061
3062 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3063 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3064
3065 @quotation Note
3066 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3067 which are not currently documented here.
3068 @end quotation
3069 @end deffn
3070
3071 @anchor{hla_interface}
3072 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3073 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3074 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3075 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3076
3077 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3078 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3079 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3080 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3081 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3082 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3083
3084 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3085 Currently Not Supported.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3089 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3093 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3097 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3101 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3102 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3103
3104 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3105 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3106 ST-LINK server software module}.
3107 @end deffn
3108
3109 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3110 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3111 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3112 @end deffn
3113 @end deffn
3114
3115 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3116 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3117 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3118 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3119 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3120
3121 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3122 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3123 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3124 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3125
3126 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3127 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3128
3129 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3130 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3131 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3132
3133 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3134 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3135 ST-LINK server software module}.
3136
3137 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3141 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3145 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3146 @end deffn
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3150 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3151 @end deffn
3152
3153 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3154 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3155 @end deffn
3156
3157 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3158 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3159 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3160 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3161 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3162
3163 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3164 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3165 XDS110 found will be used.
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3169 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3170 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3171 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3172 @end deffn
3173
3174 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3175 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3176 version).
3177 @end deffn
3178 @end deffn
3179
3180 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3181 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3182 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3183 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3184 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3185
3186 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3187
3188 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3189 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3190
3191 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3192 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3193
3194 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3195
3196 @end deffn
3197 @end deffn
3198
3199 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3200 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3201 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3202
3203 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3204 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3205 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3206 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3207 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3208 configuration on exit.
3209
3210 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3211 pinout.
3212
3213 @end deffn
3214
3215 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3216 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3217 of the one which is most popular.
3218
3219 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3220
3221 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3222 pinout.
3223
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226
3227 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3228 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3229 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3230
3231 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3232 @end deffn
3233
3234
3235 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3236 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3237 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3238
3239 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242
3243 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3244 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3245 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3246
3247 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3248 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3249 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3250
3251 @itemize @minus
3252 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3253 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3254 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3255 @end itemize
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3259 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3260 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3261 @end deffn
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264
3265 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3266 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3267 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3268 DPI server interface.
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3271 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3272 @end deffn
3273
3274 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3275 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3276 @end deffn
3277 @end deffn
3278
3279
3280 @section Transport Configuration
3281 @cindex Transport
3282 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3283 and the debug adapter you are using,
3284 several transports may be available to
3285 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3286 @deffn Command {transport list}
3287 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3288 version of OpenOCD.
3289 @end deffn
3290
3291 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3292 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3293
3294 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3295 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3296 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3297 adapter's driver).
3298
3299 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3300 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3301 supported by the debug adapter.
3302
3303 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3304 transport, if any.
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307 @subsection JTAG Transport
3308 @cindex JTAG
3309 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3310 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3311 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3312 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3313 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3314 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3315
3316 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3317 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3318 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3319 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3320 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3321
3322 @subsection SWD Transport
3323 @cindex SWD
3324 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3325 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3326 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3327 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3328 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3329 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3330 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3331
3332 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3333 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3334 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3335 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3336 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3337
3338 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3339 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3340 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3341 expected to change.
3342 @end deffn
3343 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3344 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3345 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3346 No parameters: displays current settings.
3347 @end deffn
3348
3349 @subsection SPI Transport
3350 @cindex SPI
3351 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3352 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3353 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3354 solution for flash programming.
3355
3356 @anchor{swimtransport}
3357 @subsection SWIM Transport
3358 @cindex SWIM
3359 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3360 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3361 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3362 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3363
3364 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3365
3366 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3367
3368 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3369 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3370 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3371 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3372 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3373
3374 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3375 @section JTAG Speed
3376 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3377 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3378 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3379 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3380 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3381 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3382 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3383 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3384 power management software that may be active.
3385
3386 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3387 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3388 target event handler.
3389 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3390 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3391 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3392 sets up those clocks).
3393 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3394 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3395 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3396 in the target config file.
3397 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3398 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3399 config file instead.
3400 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3401 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3402 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3403
3404 @example
3405 jtag_rclk 3000
3406 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3407 @end example
3408
3409 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3410 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3411 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3412 may not be the fastest solution.
3413
3414 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3415 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3416 which support adaptive clocking.
3417
3418 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3419 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3420 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3421 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3422 than the speed specified.
3423
3424 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3425 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3426 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3427 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3428
3429 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3430 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3431 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3432 JTAG clocking after setup.
3433 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3434 If the interface device can not
3435 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3436 @end deffn
3437
3438 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3439 @cindex adaptive clocking
3440 @cindex RTCK
3441 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3442 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3443 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3444 @example
3445 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3446 jtag_rclk 3000
3447 @end example
3448 @end defun
3449
3450 @node Reset Configuration
3451 @chapter Reset Configuration
3452 @cindex Reset Configuration
3453
3454 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3455 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3456 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3457 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3458 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3459 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3460 Please see the various board files for examples.
3461
3462 @quotation Note
3463 To maintainers and integrators:
3464 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3465 Normally the board configuration file
3466 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3467 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3468
3469 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3470 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3471 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3472 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3473 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3474 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3475 @end quotation
3476
3477 @section Types of Reset
3478
3479 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3480 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3481 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3482
3483 @itemize @bullet
3484 @item
3485 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3486 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3487 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3488 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3489 @item
3490 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3491 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3492 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3493 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3494 @item
3495 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3496 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3497 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3498 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3499 @item
3500 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3501 several other types of reset.
3502 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3503 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3504 There may be individual module resets.
3505 @end itemize
3506
3507 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3508 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3509 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3510 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3511 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3512 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3513 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3514 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3515 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3516
3517 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3518 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3519
3520 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3521 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3522 common issues are:
3523
3524 @itemize @bullet
3525
3526 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3527 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3528 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3529 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3530 when either of those signals is not connected.
3531 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3532 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3533 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3534 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3535
3536 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3537 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3538 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3539 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3540
3541 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3542 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3543 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3544 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3545 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3546 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3547 hardware debouncing.
3548 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3549 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3550
3551 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3552 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3553 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3554 to use push/pull output drivers.
3555 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3556 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3557 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3558 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3559
3560 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3561 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3562 issues (not limited to errata).
3563 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3564 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3565 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3566 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3567 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3568 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3569 @end itemize
3570
3571 There can also be other issues.
3572 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3573 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3574 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3575 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3576 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3577 Agreement (NDA).
3578
3579 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3580 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3581 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3582
3583 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3584 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3585
3586 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3587
3588 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3589 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3590 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3591 allowing it to be deasserted.
3592 @end deffn
3593
3594 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3595 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3596 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3597 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3598 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3599 @end deffn
3600
3601 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3602 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3603 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3604 allowing it to be deasserted.
3605 @end deffn
3606
3607 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3608 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3609 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3610 @end deffn
3611
3612 @anchor{reset_config}
3613 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3614 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3615 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3616 configuration scripts.
3617
3618 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3619 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3620 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3621 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3622 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3623 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3624 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3625 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3626
3627 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3628 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3629 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3630 -- may be specified at a time.
3631 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3632 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3633 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3634 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3635 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3636
3637 @itemize
3638 @item
3639 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3640 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3641 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3642 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3643 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3644
3645 @quotation Tip
3646 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3647 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3648 @end quotation
3649
3650 @item
3651 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3652 signal implementations.
3653 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3654 indicating everything behaves normally.
3655 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3656 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3657 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3658 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3659 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3660 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3661 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3662
3663 @item
3664 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3665 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3666 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3667 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3668 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3669 while SRST is asserted.
3670 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3671 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3672
3673 @item
3674 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3675 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3676 is required to use this option.
3677 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3678 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3679 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3680 be asserted before any target connection.
3681 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3682 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3683 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3684 @end itemize
3685
3686 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3687 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3688 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3689 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3690 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3691
3692 @itemize
3693 @item
3694 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3695 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3696 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3697 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3698
3699 @item
3700 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3701 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3702 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3703 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3704 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3705 @end itemize
3706 @end deffn
3707
3708 @section Custom Reset Handling
3709 @cindex events
3710
3711 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3712 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3713 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3714 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3715 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3716 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3717
3718 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3719 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3720 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3721 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3722 want to reset everything at once.
3723
3724 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3725 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3726 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3727 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3728 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3729 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3730 needs special attention.
3731
3732 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3733 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3734 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3735 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3736 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3737 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3738 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3739 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3740 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3741
3742 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3743 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3744 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3745 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3746 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3747
3748 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3749 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3750 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3751 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3752 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3753 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3754 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3755 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3756 or potentially some other value.
3757
3758 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3759 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3760 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3761 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3762 (or their associated targets)
3763 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3764
3765 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3766 they return.
3767 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3768 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3769 @end deffn
3770
3771 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3772 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3773 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3774 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3775 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3776 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3777 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3778 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3779 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3780 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3781 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3782 @end deffn
3783
3784 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3785 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3786 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3787 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3788 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3789 @end deffn
3790
3791
3792 @node TAP Declaration
3793 @chapter TAP Declaration
3794 @cindex TAP declaration
3795 @cindex TAP configuration
3796
3797 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3798 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3799
3800 @itemize @bullet
3801 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3802 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3803 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3804 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3805 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3806 start running that code.
3807 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3808 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3809 and missing connections.
3810 @end itemize
3811
3812 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3813 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3814 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3815 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3816 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3817
3818 @section Scan Chains
3819 @cindex scan chain
3820
3821 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3822 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3823 They also need to be added to
3824 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3825 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3826 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3827 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3828 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3829 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3830 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3831 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3832
3833 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3834 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3835 command, presented in the next chapter.
3836 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3837 debugging targets.)
3838 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3839
3840 @verbatim
3841 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3842 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3843 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3844 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3845 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3846 @end verbatim
3847
3848 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3849 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3850 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3851 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3852 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3853 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3854 until they are told to do so.
3855
3856 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3857 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3858 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3859 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3860
3861 @example
3862 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3863 @end example
3864
3865 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3866 by a given chip.
3867 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3868 and so forth.
3869 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3870 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3871 both inside a single chip and between them.
3872 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3873
3874 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3875 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3876 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3877 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3878 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3879 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3880 includes commands something like this:
3881
3882 @example
3883 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3884 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3885 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3886 @end example
3887
3888 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3889 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3890 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3891
3892 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3893 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3894 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3895 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3896 @example
3897 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3898 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3899 @}
3900 @end example
3901 @end deffn
3902
3903 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3904 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3905 and their status.
3906 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3907 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3908 but systems with a JTAG router can
3909 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3910 @end deffn
3911
3912 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3913 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3914
3915 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3916 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3917
3918 @section TAP Names
3919 @cindex dotted name
3920
3921 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3922 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3923 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3924 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3925 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3926 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3927 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3928 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3929
3930 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3931 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3932 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3933
3934 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3935
3936 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3937 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3938 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3939 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3940
3941 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3942 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3943 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3944 overridable.
3945
3946 @cindex TAP naming convention
3947 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3948 and should follow this convention:
3949
3950 @itemize @bullet
3951 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3952 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3953 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3954 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3955 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3956 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3957 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3958 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3959 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3960 with a single TAP;
3961 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3962 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3963 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3964 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3965 @end itemize
3966
3967 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3968
3969 @itemize @bullet
3970 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3971 @*The length in bits of the
3972 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3973 @end itemize
3974
3975 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3976
3977 @itemize @bullet
3978 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3979 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3980 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3981 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3982 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3983 (the TAP is linked in).
3984 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3985 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3986 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3987 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3988 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3989 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3990 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3991 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3992 values that were found but not included in the list.
3993
3994 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3995 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3996 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3997 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3998 hardware to find these values.
3999 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4000 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4001 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4002 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4003 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4004 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4005 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4006 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4007 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4008 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4009 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4010 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4011 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4012 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4013 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4014 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4015 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4016 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4017 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4018 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4019 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4020 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4021 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4022 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4023 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4024 @end itemize
4025 @end deffn
4026
4027 @section Other TAP commands
4028
4029 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4030 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4031 @end deffn
4032
4033 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4034 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4035 At this writing this TAP attribute
4036 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4037 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4038 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4039 See the next section for information about the available events.
4040
4041 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4042 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4043 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4044 @end deffn
4045
4046 @section TAP Events
4047 @cindex events
4048 @cindex TAP events
4049
4050 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4051 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4052 The other applies to debugger targets,
4053 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4054
4055 The TAP events currently defined are:
4056
4057 @itemize @bullet
4058 @item @b{post-reset}
4059 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4060 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4061 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4062 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4063 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4064
4065 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4066 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4067 of any particular target.
4068 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4069 @item @b{setup}
4070 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4071 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4072 @item @b{tap-disable}
4073 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4074 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4075 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4076 @item @b{tap-enable}
4077 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4078 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4079 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4080 @end itemize
4081
4082 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4083 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4084 contents to be accurate), you might:
4085
4086 @example
4087 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4088 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4089 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4090 @}
4091 @end example
4092
4093
4094 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4095 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4096 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4097 @cindex jrc
4098
4099 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4100 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4101 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4102 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4103 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4104
4105 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4106 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4107 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4108 be visible.
4109 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4110 ignores, such as:
4111
4112 @itemize
4113 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4114 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4115 TAPs receive new instructions.
4116 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4117 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4118 @end itemize
4119
4120 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4121 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4122 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4123 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4124
4125 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4126 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4127
4128 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4129 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4130 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4131 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4132 should define TAP event handlers using
4133 code that looks something like this:
4134
4135 @example
4136 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4137 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4138 @}
4139 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4140 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4141 @}
4142 @end example
4143
4144 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4145
4146 @example
4147 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4148 @end example
4149
4150 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4151 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4152 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4153 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4154
4155 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4156 If necessary, disables the tap
4157 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4158 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4159 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4160 and "0" if it is disabled.
4161 @end deffn
4162
4163 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4164 If necessary, enables the tap
4165 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4166 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4167 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4168 and "0" if it is disabled.
4169 @end deffn
4170
4171 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4172 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4173 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4174 and "0" if it is disabled.
4175
4176 @quotation Note
4177 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4178 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4179 @end quotation
4180 @end deffn
4181
4182 @anchor{autoprobing}
4183 @section Autoprobing
4184 @cindex autoprobe
4185 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4186
4187 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4188 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4189 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4190 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4191
4192 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4193 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4194 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4195 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4196 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4197 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4198 right when they come out of reset).
4199
4200 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4201
4202 @example
4203 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4204 reset_config trst_and_srst
4205 jtag_rclk 8
4206 @end example
4207
4208 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4209 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4210
4211 @enumerate
4212 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4213 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4214 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4215 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4216 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4217 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4218 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4219 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4220 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4221 that is discovered.
4222 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4223 register, it will report it.
4224 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4225 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4226 @end enumerate
4227
4228 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4229 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4230 that's a bit more complex:
4231
4232 @example
4233 clock speed 8 kHz
4234 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4235 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4236 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4237 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4238 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4239 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4240 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4241 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4242 @end example
4243
4244 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4245 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4246 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4247 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4248 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4249 and so forth.
4250
4251 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4252 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4253 @cindex DAP declaration
4254
4255 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4256 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4257 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4258 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4259 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4260
4261 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4262
4263 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4264 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4265 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4266 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4267 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4268
4269 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4270
4271 @itemize @bullet
4272 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4273 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4274 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4275 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4276 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4277 @end itemize
4278 @end deffn
4279
4280 @deffn Command {dap names}
4281 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4282 for TCL scripting.
4283 @end deffn
4284
4285 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4286 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4287 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4288 @end deffn
4289
4290 @deffn Command {dap init}
4291 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4292 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4293 initialization, too.
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4297
4298 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4299 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4300 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4301 @end deffn
4302
4303 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4304 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4305 @end deffn
4306
4307 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4308 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4309 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4310 or set a new value @var{value}.
4311 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4312 @end deffn
4313
4314 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4315 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4316 @end deffn
4317
4318 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4319 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4320 value @var{value}.
4321
4322 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4323 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4324 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4325
4326 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4327 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4331 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4332 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4333 @end deffn
4334
4335 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4336 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4337 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4338 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4339 @end deffn
4340
4341 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4342 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4343
4344 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4345 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4346 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4347 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4348 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4349 for details.
4350
4351 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4352 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4353 the pattern:
4354 @example
4355 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4356 @end example
4357
4358 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4359 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4360 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4361 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4362 @example
4363 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4364 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4365 @end example
4366
4367 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4368 @example
4369 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4370 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4371 @end example
4372
4373 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4374 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4375
4376 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4377 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4378 example with a proper dap name:
4379 @example
4380 xxx.dap apcsw default
4381 @end example
4382 @end deffn
4383
4384 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4385 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4386 Disabled by default
4387 @end deffn
4388
4389
4390 @node CPU Configuration
4391 @chapter CPU Configuration
4392 @cindex GDB target
4393
4394 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4395 You can also access these targets without GDB
4396 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4397 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4398 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4399 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4400
4401 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4402 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4403
4404 @section Target List
4405 @cindex target, current
4406 @cindex target, list
4407
4408 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4409 where each member has a name.
4410 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4411 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4412 (plural!) command.
4413 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4414 look like with more than one:
4415 @verbatim
4416 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4417 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4418 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4419 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4420 @end verbatim
4421
4422 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4423 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4424 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4425 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4426 space seen by that current target.
4427 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4428 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4429 are examples; and there are many more.
4430
4431 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4432
4433 @deffn Command {target current}
4434 Returns the name of the current target.
4435 @end deffn
4436
4437 @deffn Command {target names}
4438 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4439 @example
4440 foreach t [target names] @{
4441 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4442 @}
4443 @end example
4444 @end deffn
4445
4446 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4447 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4448
4449 @deffn Command targets [name]
4450 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4451 command names are singular.}
4452
4453 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4454 targets in a user friendly form.
4455
4456 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4457 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4458 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4459 @end deffn
4460
4461 @section Target CPU Types
4462 @cindex target type
4463 @cindex CPU type
4464
4465 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4466 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4467 when calling @command{target create}.
4468 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4469 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4470 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4471 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4472 what core-specific commands may be available
4473 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4474 and more.
4475
4476 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4477 since there's a command to list them.
4478
4479 @anchor{targettypes}
4480 @deffn Command {target types}
4481 Lists all supported target types.
4482 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4483
4484 @itemize @bullet
4485 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4486 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4487 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4488 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4489 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4490 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4491 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4492 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4493 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4494 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4495 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4496 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4497 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4498 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4499 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4500 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4501 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4502 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4503 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4504 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4505 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4506 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4507 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4508 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4509 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4510 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4511 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4512 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4513 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4514 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4515 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4516 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4517 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4518 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4519 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4520 @itemize @minus
4521 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4522 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4523 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4524 @end itemize
4525 And two debug interfaces cores:
4526 @itemize @minus
4527 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4528 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4529 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4530 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4531 @end itemize
4532 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4533 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4534 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4535 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4536 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4537 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4538 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4539 @end itemize
4540 @end deffn
4541
4542 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4543 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4544 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4545 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4546 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4547 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4548 reflect design generations;
4549 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4550 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4551
4552 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4553 @section Target Configuration
4554
4555 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4556 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4557 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4558 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4559 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4560
4561 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4562 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4563 optional parts.
4564 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4565 command, created as part of target creation.
4566
4567 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4568 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4569 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4570 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4571 to be much more board-specific.
4572 The key steps you use might look something like this
4573
4574 @example
4575 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4576 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4577 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4578 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4579 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4580 @end example
4581
4582 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4583 on-chip SRAM.
4584 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4585 writes to target memory;
4586 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4587 GDB memory checksumming;
4588 and more.
4589
4590 @quotation Warning
4591 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4592 inaccessible when application code
4593 (such as an operating system)
4594 enables or disables the MMU.
4595 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4596 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4597 easy access to other addresses needed.
4598 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4599 @end quotation
4600
4601 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4602 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4603 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4604 controllers.
4605 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4606 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4607 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4608
4609 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4610 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4611 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4612 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4613 purposes including additional configuration.
4614
4615 @itemize @bullet
4616 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4617 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4618 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4619 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4620
4621 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4622 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4623 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4624 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4625 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4626 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4627 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4628
4629 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4630 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4631 @end itemize
4632 @end deffn
4633
4634 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4635 The options accepted by this command may also be
4636 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4637 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4638 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4639
4640 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4641 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4642 and changing its endianness.
4643
4644 @itemize @bullet
4645
4646 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4647 used to access this target.
4648
4649 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4650 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4651 create and manage DAP instances.
4652
4653 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4654 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4655
4656 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4657 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4658 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4659 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4660 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4661 same event name assigns only one handler.
4662
4663 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4664 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4665
4666 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4667 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4668 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4669 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4670 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4671 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4672 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4673
4674 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4675 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4676 or virtual address is being used.
4677
4678 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4679 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4680
4681 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4682 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4683 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4684 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4685 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4686
4687 @anchor{rtostype}
4688 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4689 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4690 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4691 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4692 @option{RIOT}
4693 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4694
4695 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4696 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4697 access the target for debugging.
4698
4699 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4700 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4701 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4702 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4703
4704 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4705 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4706 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4707 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4708 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4709
4710 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4711 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4712 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4713 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4714 command @command{gdb_port}.
4715 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4716
4717 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4718 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4719 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4720 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4721 @end itemize
4722 @end deffn
4723
4724 @section Other $target_name Commands
4725 @cindex object command
4726
4727 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4728 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4729
4730 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4731 Once a button is created a button
4732 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4733 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4734 configure it like this:
4735
4736 @example
4737 # Create
4738 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4739 # Modify
4740 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4741 # Query
4742 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4743 # Report
4744 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4745 @end example
4746
4747 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4748 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4749
4750 @example
4751 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4752 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4753 @end example
4754
4755 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4756
4757 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4758 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4759 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4760 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4761 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4762 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4763 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4764 They are not otherwise documented here.
4765 @end deffn
4766
4767 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4768 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4769 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4770 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4771 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4772 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4773 the target side uses raw memory.
4774
4775 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4776 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4777 The script orientation comes from working with data
4778 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4779 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4780 and neither store nor return those values.
4781
4782 @itemize
4783 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4784 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4785 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4786 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4787 @end itemize
4788 @end deffn
4789
4790 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4791 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4792 @command{$target_name configure}
4793 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4794 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4795 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4796 There are a few special cases:
4797
4798 @itemize @bullet
4799 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4800 event named @var{event_name}.
4801 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4802 two parameters.
4803 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4804 This is a special case because this is set using
4805 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4806 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4807 @end itemize
4808
4809 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4810 all the targets you might use something like this:
4811
4812 @example
4813 foreach name [target names] @{
4814 set y [$name cget -endian]
4815 set z [$name cget -type]
4816 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4817 $x $name $y $z]
4818 @}
4819 @end example
4820 @end deffn
4821
4822 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4823 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4824 Displays the current target state:
4825 @code{debug-running},
4826 @code{halted},
4827 @code{reset},
4828 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4829 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4830 @end deffn
4831
4832 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4833 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4834 currently associated with this target.
4835 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4836 @end deffn
4837
4838 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4839 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4840 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4841 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4842 @end deffn
4843
4844 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4845 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4846 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4847 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4848 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4849 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4850 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4851 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4852 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4853 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4854 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4855 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4856 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4857 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4858 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4859 @end deffn
4860
4861 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4862 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4863 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4864 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4865 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4866 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4867 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4868 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4869 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4870 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4871 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4872 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4873 @end deffn
4874
4875 @anchor{targetevents}
4876 @section Target Events
4877 @cindex target events
4878 @cindex events
4879 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4880 For example:
4881 @itemize @bullet
4882 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4883 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4884 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4885 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4886 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4887 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4888 to set up system clocks or
4889 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4890 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4891 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4892 @end itemize
4893
4894 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4895 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4896 @command{target create ... -event}.
4897
4898 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4899 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4900 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4901
4902 @example
4903 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4904 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4905 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4906 @}
4907 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4908 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4909 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4910 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4911 @}
4912 @end example
4913
4914 The following target events are defined:
4915
4916 @itemize @bullet
4917 @item @b{debug-halted}
4918 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4919 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4920 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4921 @item @b{early-halted}
4922 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4923 @item @b{examine-start}
4924 @* Before target examine is called.
4925 @item @b{examine-end}
4926 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4927 @item @b{examine-fail}
4928 @* After target examine fails.
4929 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4930 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4931 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4932 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4933 connect GDB to running target.
4934 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4935 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4936 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4937 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4938 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4939 is in RAM or read only memory.
4940 Default is @code{halt}
4941 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4942 @* When GDB disconnects
4943 @item @b{gdb-end}
4944 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4945 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4946 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4947 @code{reset init})
4948 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4949 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4950 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4951 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4952 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4953 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4954 @item @b{gdb-start}
4955 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4956 @item @b{halted}
4957 @* The target has halted
4958 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4959 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4960 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4961 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4962 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4963 @item @b{reset-assert}
4964 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4965 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4966 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4967 it instead of asserting SRST.
4968 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4969 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4970 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4971 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4972 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4973 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4974 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4975 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4976 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4977 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4978 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4979 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4980 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4981 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4982 released on the scan chain.
4983 @item @b{reset-end}
4984 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4985 @item @b{reset-init}
4986 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4987 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4988
4989 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4990 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4991 multiplexing, and so on.
4992 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4993 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4994 @item @b{reset-start}
4995 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4996 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4997
4998 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4999 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5000 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5001 @item @b{resume-start}
5002 @* Before any target is resumed
5003 @item @b{resume-end}
5004 @* After all targets have resumed
5005 @item @b{resumed}
5006 @* Target has resumed
5007 @item @b{step-start}
5008 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5009 @item @b{step-end}
5010 @* After single-step has completed
5011 @item @b{trace-config}
5012 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5013 @end itemize
5014
5015 @quotation Note
5016 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5017 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5018 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5019 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5020 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5021 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5022 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5023 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5024 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5025 check if the core has changed status.
5026 @end quotation
5027
5028 @node Flash Commands
5029 @chapter Flash Commands
5030
5031 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5032 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5033 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5034 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5035 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5036 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5037 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5038 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5039 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5040
5041 Flash Steps:
5042 @enumerate
5043 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5044 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5045 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5046 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5047 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5048 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5049 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5050 @item GDB Flashing
5051 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5052 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5053 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5054 @end enumerate
5055
5056 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5057 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5058 so that it can't boot.
5059 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5060 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5061
5062 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5063 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5064 @cindex flash configuration
5065
5066 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5067 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5068 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5069 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5070 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5071 see the driver-specific documentation.
5072
5073 @itemize @bullet
5074 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5075 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5076 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5077 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5078 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5079 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5080 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5081 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5082 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5083 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5084 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5085 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5086 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5087 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5088 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5089 commands to the flash controller.
5090 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5091 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5092 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5093 for more information.
5094 @end itemize
5095 @quotation Note
5096 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5097 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5098 @end quotation
5099 @end deffn
5100
5101 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5102 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5103 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5104 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5105 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5106 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5107 @end deffn
5108
5109 @deffn Command {flash list}
5110 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5111 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5112 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5113 @end deffn
5114
5115 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5116 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5117 depends on the flash type.
5118 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5119 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5120 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5121 but most don't bother.
5122 @end deffn
5123
5124 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5125
5126 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5127 begins.
5128
5129 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5130 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5131 until the programming session is finished.
5132
5133 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5134 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5135
5136 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5137
5138 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5139 @cindex flash erasing
5140 @cindex flash reading
5141 @cindex flash writing
5142 @cindex flash programming
5143 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5144
5145 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5146 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5147 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5148 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5149 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5150
5151 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5152 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5153 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5154 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5155 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5156
5157 @quotation Note
5158 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5159 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5160 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5161 back to a flash bank.
5162 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5163 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5164 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5165 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5166 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5167 @end quotation
5168
5169 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5170 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5171 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5172 disabled first.
5173 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5174 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5175 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5176
5177 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5178 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5179 up to and including @var{last}.
5180 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5181 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5182 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5183 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5184 @end deffn
5185
5186 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5187 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5188 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5189 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5190 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5191 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5192 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5193 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5194 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5195 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5196 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5197 before erase starts.
5198 @end deffn
5199
5200 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5201 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5202 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5203 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5204 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5205 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5206 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5207 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5208 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5209 before issuing this command.
5210 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5211 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5212 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5213 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5214 @end deffn
5215 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5216
5217 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5218 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5219 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5220 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5221 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5222 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5223 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5224 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5225 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5226 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5227 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5228 @end deffn
5229
5230 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5231 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5232 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5233 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5234 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5235 @end deffn
5236
5237 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5238 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5239 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5240 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5241 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5242 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5243 @end deffn
5244
5245 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5246 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5247 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5248 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5249 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5250 @end deffn
5251
5252 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5253 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5254 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5255 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5256 to the base address for each section in the image.
5257 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5258 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5259 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5260 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5261 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5262 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5263 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5264 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5265 each image section.
5266
5267 @quotation Warning
5268 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5269 data you want to preserve.
5270 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5271 sections might be erased with no notice.
5272 @itemize
5273 @item
5274 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5275 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5276 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5277 @item
5278 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5279 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5280 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5281 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5282 @end itemize
5283 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5284 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5285 @end quotation
5286
5287 @end deffn
5288
5289 @deffn Command {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5290 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5291 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5292 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5293 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5294 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5295 ordinary memory reads.
5296 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5297 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5298 check for successful programming.
5299 @end deffn
5300
5301 @section Other Flash commands
5302 @cindex flash protection
5303
5304 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5305 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5306 and display that status.
5307 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5308 @end deffn
5309
5310 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5311 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5312 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5313
5314 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5315 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5316 and possibly stale information.
5317 @end deffn
5318
5319 @anchor{flashprotect}
5320 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5321 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5322 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5323 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5324 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5325 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5326 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5327 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5328 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5329 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5330 @end deffn
5331
5332 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5333 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5334 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5335 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5336 @end deffn
5337
5338 @anchor{program}
5339 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5340 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5341 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5342 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5343 @end deffn
5344
5345 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5346 @section Flash Driver List
5347 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5348 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5349 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5350
5351 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5352 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5353 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5354
5355 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5356
5357 @itemize
5358 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5359 @end itemize
5360
5361 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5362 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5363 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5364 @example
5365 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5366 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5367 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5368 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5369 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5370 @end example
5371 @end deffn
5372
5373 @subsection External Flash
5374
5375 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5376 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5377 @cindex CFI
5378 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5379 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5380 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5381 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5382 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5383 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5384 configure a bus and its timings), or
5385 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5386 on the flash chip.
5387 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5388 speed up operation.
5389
5390 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5391
5392 @itemize
5393 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5394 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5395 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5396 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5397 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5398 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5399 @end itemize
5400
5401 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5402 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5403
5404 @example
5405 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5406 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5407 @end example
5408
5409 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5410 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5411 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5412
5413 @example
5414 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5415 @end example
5416
5417 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5418 @end deffn
5419
5420 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5421 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5422 @cindex SPI
5423 @cindex jtagspi
5424 @cindex bscan_spi
5425 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5426 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5427 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5428 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5429 accessed through JTAG.
5430
5431 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5432 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5433 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5434 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5435 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5436 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5437
5438 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5439 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5440 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5441 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5442 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5443 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5444 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5445 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5446
5447 @itemize
5448 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5449 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5450 @var{USER1} instruction.
5451 @end itemize
5452
5453 @example
5454 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5455 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5456 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5457 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5458 @end example
5459 @end deffn
5460
5461 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5462 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5463 @cindex xcf
5464 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5465 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5466 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5467 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5468 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5469
5470 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5471 command accepts additional parameters:
5472 @itemize
5473 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5474 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5475 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5476 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5477 in master mode.
5478 @end itemize
5479 @example
5480 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5481 @end example
5482 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5483 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5484 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5485 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5486 dedicated sector.
5487 @end deffn
5488
5489 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5490 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5491 button.
5492 @example
5493 xcf configure 0
5494 @end example
5495 @end deffn
5496
5497 Additional driver notes:
5498 @itemize
5499 @item Only single revision supported.
5500 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5501 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5502 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5503 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5504 @end itemize
5505 @end deffn
5506
5507 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5508 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5509 @cindex SPIFI
5510 @cindex lpcspifi
5511 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5512 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5513 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5514
5515 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5516 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5517 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5518 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5519 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5520
5521 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5522 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5523 are configured by the driver.
5524
5525 @example
5526 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5527 @end example
5528
5529 @end deffn
5530
5531 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5532 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5533 @cindex SMI
5534 @cindex stmsmi
5535 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5536 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5537 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5538 SPI flash devices.
5539 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5540 flash devices can be connected.
5541
5542 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5543 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5544 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5545 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5546 the flash content.
5547
5548 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5549 to identify the memory bank.
5550 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5551 flash size, are detected automatically.
5552
5553 @example
5554 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5555 @end example
5556
5557 @end deffn
5558
5559 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmqspi
5560 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5561 @cindex QuadSPI
5562 @cindex OctoSPI
5563 @cindex stmqspi
5564 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5565 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5566 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5567 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5568 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5569 mode is not.
5570
5571 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5572 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5573 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5574 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5575
5576 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5577 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5578 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5579
5580 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5581 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5582 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5583 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5584 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5585 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5586
5587 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5588 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5589 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5590 should be avoided.
5591
5592 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5593 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5594 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5595 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5596 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5597 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5598
5599 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5600 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5601 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5602 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5603 persist across openocd invocations.
5604
5605 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5606 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5607 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5608 required (see 'set' command).
5609
5610 @example
5611 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5612 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5613 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5614 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5615 @end example
5616
5617 There are three specific commands
5618 @deffn Command {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5619 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5620 chip specific write protection engaged.
5621 @end deffn
5622
5623 @deffn Command {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5624 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5625 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5626 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5627 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5628 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5629
5630 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5631 which don't support an id command.
5632
5633 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5634 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5635 @end deffn
5636
5637 @deffn Command {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5638 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5639 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5640 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5641 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5642
5643 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5644 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5645 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5646 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5647
5648 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5649
5650 To check basic communication settings, issue
5651 @example
5652 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5653 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5654 @end example
5655 for single flash mode or
5656 @example
5657 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5658 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5659 @end example
5660 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5661
5662 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5663 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5664 need a dummy address, e.g.
5665 @example
5666 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5667 @end example
5668 should return the status register contents.
5669
5670 @end deffn
5671
5672 @end deffn
5673
5674 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5675 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5676 Microcontroller platform.
5677
5678 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5679 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5680
5681 @example
5682 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5683 @end example
5684
5685 @end deffn
5686
5687 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5688 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5689 @cindex ath79
5690 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5691 chip selects.
5692 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5693 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5694 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5695 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5696 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5697 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5698
5699 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5700 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5701 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5702 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5703 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5704 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5705 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5706 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5707 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5708 with the default CS0.
5709 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5710 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5711 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5712
5713 @example
5714 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5715
5716 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5717 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5718 # distinguish the banks.
5719 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5720 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5721 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5722 @end example
5723
5724 @end deffn
5725
5726 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5727 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5728 @cindex fespi
5729
5730 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5731
5732 @example
5733 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5734 @end example
5735 @end deffn
5736
5737 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5738
5739 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5740 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5741 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5742 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5743 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5744 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5745
5746 @example
5747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5748 @end example
5749 @end deffn
5750
5751 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5752 @cindex ambiqmicro
5753 @cindex apollo
5754 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5755 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5756 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5757 with the target using SWD.
5758
5759 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5760 the device class of the MCU.
5761 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5762 to set up the flash banks.
5763 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5764 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5765
5766 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5767 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5768 and the second bank starts after the first.
5769
5770 @example
5771 # Flash bank 0
5772 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5773 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5774 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5775 $_TARGETNAME
5776 @end example
5777
5778 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5779 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5780 are available to the user.
5781
5782 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5783
5784 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5785 Erase entire bank.
5786 @end deffn
5787 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5788 Erase device pages.
5789 @end deffn
5790 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5791 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5792 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5793 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5794 the flash.
5795 @end deffn
5796 @end deffn
5797
5798 @anchor{at91samd}
5799 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5800 @cindex at91samd
5801 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5802 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5803
5804 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5805
5806 The devices have one flash bank:
5807
5808 @example
5809 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5810 @end example
5811
5812 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5813 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5814 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5815 processor to be halted.
5816 @end deffn
5817
5818 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5819 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5820 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5821 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5822 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5823 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5824
5825 @example
5826 at91samd set-security enable
5827 @end example
5828 @end deffn
5829
5830 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5831 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5832 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5833 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5834 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5835 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5836 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5837 in order to disable this feature.
5838
5839 @example
5840 at91samd eeprom
5841 at91samd eeprom 1024
5842 @end example
5843 @end deffn
5844
5845 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5846 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5847 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5848 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5849 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5850 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5851
5852 @example
5853 at91samd bootloader
5854 at91samd bootloader 16384
5855 @end example
5856 @end deffn
5857
5858 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5859 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5860 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5861 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5862 @end deffn
5863
5864 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5865 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5866 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5867 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5868 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5869 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5870 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5871 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5872
5873 @example
5874 # Read user row
5875 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5876 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5877 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5878 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5879 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
5880 # byte unchanged
5881 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5882 @end example
5883 @end deffn
5884
5885 @end deffn
5886
5887 @anchor{at91sam3}
5888 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5889 @cindex at91sam3
5890 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5891 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5892 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5893 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5894 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5895 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5896 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5897 chips are confirmed.}
5898
5899 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5900 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5901 the following fixed locations:
5902
5903 @example
5904 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5905 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5906 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5907 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5908 @end example
5909
5910 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5911 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5912 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5913
5914 @itemize
5915 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5916 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5917 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5918 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5919 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5920 @end itemize
5921
5922 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5923
5924 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5925 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5926 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5927 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5928 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5929 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5930 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5931
5932 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5933 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5934 @end deffn
5935
5936 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5937 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5938 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5939 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5940 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5941 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5942 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5943 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5944 @end deffn
5945
5946 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5947 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5948 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5949 @end deffn
5950 @end deffn
5951
5952 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5953 @cindex at91sam4
5954 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5955 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5956 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5957 @end deffn
5958
5959 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5960 @cindex at91sam4l
5961 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5962 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5963 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5964
5965 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5966 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5967 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5968 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5969 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5970 @end deffn
5971 @end deffn
5972
5973 @anchor{atsame5}
5974 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5975 @cindex atsame5
5976 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5977 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5978 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5979
5980 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5981 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5982 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5983
5984 @example
5985 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5986 @end example
5987
5988 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5989 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5990 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5991 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5992 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5993 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5994
5995 @example
5996 atsame5 bootloader
5997 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5998 @end example
5999 @end deffn
6000
6001 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
6002 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6003 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6004 processor to be halted.
6005 @end deffn
6006
6007 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6008 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6009 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6010 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6011 @end deffn
6012
6013 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
6014 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6015 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6016 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6017 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6018 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6019 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6020 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6021
6022 @example
6023 # Read
6024 >atsame5 userpage
6025 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6026 # Write
6027 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6028 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6029 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6030 # bytes)
6031 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6032 @end example
6033 @end deffn
6034
6035 @end deffn
6036
6037 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
6038 @cindex atsamv
6039 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6040 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6041 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6042 @end deffn
6043
6044 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
6045 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6046 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6047 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6048 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6049
6050 @example
6051 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6052 @end example
6053
6054 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6055 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6056
6057 @itemize
6058 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6059 @item @var{banks}
6060 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6061 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6062 @item @var{pages_size}
6063 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6064 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6065 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6066 @end itemize
6067
6068 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6069 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6070 will be autoconfigured.
6071 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6072
6073 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6074 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6075 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6076 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6077 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6078
6079 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6080 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6081 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6082 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6083 are not truly general purpose).
6084 @quotation Note
6085 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6086 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6087 @end quotation
6088 @end deffn
6089 @end deffn
6090
6091 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
6092 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6093 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6094 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6095 @end deffn
6096
6097 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
6098 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6099 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6100 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6101
6102 @example
6103 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6104 @end example
6105
6106 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6107 each single sector one by one.
6108
6109 @example
6110 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6111 @end example
6112
6113 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6114 @end deffn
6115
6116 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
6117 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6118 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6119 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6120 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6121 starts at address 0.
6122
6123 @example
6124 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6125 @end example
6126 @end deffn
6127
6128 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
6129 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6130 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6131 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6132 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6133 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6134 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6135 and programming the serial flash.
6136
6137 @example
6138 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6139 @end example
6140 @end deffn
6141
6142 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
6143 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6144 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6145 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6146 autoconfigures itself.
6147 @example
6148 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6149 @end example
6150 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6151 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6152 this via the following command:
6153 @example
6154 efm32 debuglock num
6155 @end example
6156 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6157 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6158 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6159 supported.}
6160 @end deffn
6161
6162 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
6163 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6164 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6165 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6166 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6167 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6168
6169 @example
6170 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6171 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6172 @end example
6173
6174 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6175 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6176 @end deffn
6177
6178 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6179 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6180 is an uncommon operation.}
6181 @end deffn
6182 @end deffn
6183
6184 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6185 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6186 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6187 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6188 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6189 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6190 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6191
6192 @example
6193 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6194 @end example
6195 @end deffn
6196
6197 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6198 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6199 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6200 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6201 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6202 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6203 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6204 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6205 characters) ignored.
6206
6207 @example
6208 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6209 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6210 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6211 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6212 @end example
6213 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6214 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6215 @end deffn
6216
6217 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6218 @cindex kinetis
6219 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6220 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6221 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6222 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6223 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6224 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6225
6226 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6227 @itemize
6228 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6229 @end itemize
6230
6231 @example
6232 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6233 @end example
6234
6235 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6236 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6237 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6238 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6239 @end deffn
6240
6241 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6242 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6243 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6244 set by 'flash protect' command.
6245 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6246 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6247 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6248 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6249 with the rest of a flash image.
6250 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6251 @end deffn
6252
6253 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6254 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6255 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6256 @end deffn
6257
6258 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6259 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6260 and examine-fail event.
6261 @end deffn
6262
6263 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6264 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6265 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6266 @end deffn
6267
6268 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6269 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6270 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6271 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6272 command completes.
6273 @end deffn
6274
6275 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6276 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6277 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6278 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6279 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6280
6281 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6282 Program Partition command.
6283
6284 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6285 Reset the device after partition setting.
6286
6287 Show partition size:
6288 @example
6289 kinetis nvm_partition info
6290 @end example
6291
6292 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6293 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6294 @example
6295 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6296 @end example
6297
6298 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6299 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6300 @example
6301 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6302 @end example
6303 @end deffn
6304
6305 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6306 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6307 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6308 @end deffn
6309
6310 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6311 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6312 Command disables watchdog timer.
6313 @end deffn
6314 @end deffn
6315
6316 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6317 @cindex kinetis_ke
6318 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6319 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6320 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6321 autoconfigures itself.
6322 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6323
6324 @example
6325 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6326 @end example
6327
6328 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6329 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6330 @end deffn
6331
6332 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6333 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6334 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6335 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6336 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6337 @end deffn
6338
6339 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6340 Command disables watchdog timer.
6341 @end deffn
6342 @end deffn
6343
6344 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6345 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6346 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6347 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6348 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6349
6350 @quotation Note
6351 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6352 driver:
6353 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6354 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6355 @end quotation
6356
6357 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6358 which must appear in the following order:
6359
6360 @itemize
6361 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6362 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6363 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6364 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6365 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6366 LPC43x[2357])
6367 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6368 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6369 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6370 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6371 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6372 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6373 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6374 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6375 at which the core is running
6376 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6377 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6378 @quotation Note
6379 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6380 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6381 However, if you do provide it,
6382 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6383 @end quotation
6384 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6385 ROM IAP entry point.
6386 @end itemize
6387
6388 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6389
6390 @example
6391 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6392 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6393 @end example
6394
6395 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6396 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6397 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6398 @end deffn
6399 @end deffn
6400
6401 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6402 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6403 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6404 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6405 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6406 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6407
6408 @example
6409 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6410 @end example
6411 @end deffn
6412
6413 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6414 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6415 from NXP.
6416
6417 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6418 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6419 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6420 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6421 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6422 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6423 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6424 you start the PLL.
6425
6426 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6427
6428 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6429 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6430 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6431
6432 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6433 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6434 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6435 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6436 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6437 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6438 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6439
6440 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6441 @example
6442 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6443 @end example
6444
6445 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6446 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6447 @code{flash banks} command.
6448
6449 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6450 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6451 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6452 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6453 a known signature.
6454 Example:
6455 @example
6456 lpc2900 signature 0
6457 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6458 @end example
6459 @end deffn
6460
6461 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6462 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6463 saves it to a file in binary format.
6464 Example:
6465 @example
6466 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6467 @end example
6468 @end deffn
6469
6470 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6471 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6472 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6473 command:
6474
6475 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6476 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6477 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6478 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6479
6480 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6481 Example:
6482 @example
6483 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6484 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6485 @end example
6486 @end deffn
6487
6488 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6489 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6490 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6491 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6492 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6493 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6494 912 bytes.
6495 @quotation Attention
6496 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6497 @end quotation
6498 Example:
6499 @example
6500 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6501 @end example
6502 @end deffn
6503
6504 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6505 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6506 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6507 after the next power cycle.
6508 @quotation Attention
6509 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6510 @end quotation
6511 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6512 Example:
6513 @example
6514 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6515 flash info 0
6516 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6517 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6518 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6519 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6520 @end example
6521 @end deffn
6522
6523 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6524 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6525 effective after the next power cycle.
6526 @quotation Attention
6527 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6528 @end quotation
6529 Examples:
6530 @example
6531 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6532 @end example
6533 @end deffn
6534 @end deffn
6535
6536 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6537 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6538 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6539 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6540
6541 @example
6542 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6543 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6544 @end example
6545
6546 @itemize @bullet
6547 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6548 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6549 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6550 @end itemize
6551
6552 Example usage:
6553 @example
6554 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6555 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6556 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6557 @} else @{
6558 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6559 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6560 @}
6561 @end example
6562 @end deffn
6563
6564 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6565 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6566 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6567 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6568 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6569 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6570
6571 @example
6572 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6573 @end example
6574
6575 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6576 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6577 only the main program flash.
6578
6579 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6580 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6581 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6582 @end deffn
6583
6584 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6585 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6586 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6587 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6588
6589 To erase and program the BSL:
6590 @example
6591 msp432 bsl unlock
6592 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6593 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6594 msp432 bsl lock
6595 @end example
6596 @end deffn
6597 @end deffn
6598
6599 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6600 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6601 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6602 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6603 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6604 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6605 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6606 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6607 also have division into regions: main and info.
6608 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6609 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6610
6611 @example
6612 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6613 @end example
6614
6615 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6616
6617 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6618 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6622 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6623 @end deffn
6624
6625 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6626 Erase all userflash including info region.
6627 @end deffn
6628
6629 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6630 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6631 @end deffn
6632
6633 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6634 Check sectors protect.
6635 @end deffn
6636
6637 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6638 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6639 @end deffn
6640
6641 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6642 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6643 @end deffn
6644
6645 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6646 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6647 @end deffn
6648
6649 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6650 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6651 @end deffn
6652
6653 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6654 Show information about flash driver.
6655 @end deffn
6656
6657 @end deffn
6658
6659 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6660 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6661 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6662 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6663 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6664
6665 @example
6666 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6667 @end example
6668
6669 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6670
6671 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6672 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6673 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6674 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6675 code.
6676 @end deffn
6677
6678 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6679 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6680 @end deffn
6681
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6685 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6686 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6687
6688 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6689 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6690 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6691 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6692
6693 @example
6694 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6695 @end example
6696 @end deffn
6697
6698 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6699 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6700 and integrate flash memory.
6701
6702 @example
6703 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6704 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6705 @end example
6706
6707 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6708 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6709 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6710 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6711 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6712 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6713 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6714 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6715 @end deffn
6716 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6717 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6718 This will remove any Code Protection.
6719 @end deffn
6720 @end deffn
6721
6722 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6723 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6724 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6725 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6726 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6727
6728 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6729 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6730
6731 @example
6732 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6733 @end example
6734
6735 psoc4-specific commands
6736 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6737 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6738
6739 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6740 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6741
6742 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6743 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6744 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6745
6746 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6747 @end deffn
6748
6749 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6750 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6751
6752 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6753 @end deffn
6754 @end deffn
6755
6756 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6757 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6758 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6759 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6760 apart from the base address.
6761
6762 @example
6763 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6764 @end example
6765
6766 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6767 @quotation Attention
6768 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6769 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6770 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6771 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6772 @end quotation
6773
6774 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6775
6776 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6777 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6778 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6779 @end deffn
6780 @end deffn
6781
6782 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6783 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6784 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6785 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6786 apart from the base address.
6787
6788 @example
6789 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6790 $_TARGETNAME
6791 @end example
6792 @end deffn
6793
6794 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6795 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6796 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6797 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6798
6799 @example
6800 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6801 @end example
6802
6803 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6804
6805 @itemize
6806 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6807 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6808 @end itemize
6809
6810 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6811
6812 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6813 @quotation Attention
6814 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6815 after successful write.
6816 @end quotation
6817 @end deffn
6818
6819 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6820 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6821 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6822 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6823
6824 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6825 @itemize @bullet
6826 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6827 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6828 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6829 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6830 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6831 row size: 512 bytes.
6832 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6833 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6834 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6835 operation will erase row automatically.
6836 @end itemize
6837
6838 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6839 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6840
6841 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6842
6843 @example
6844 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6845 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6846 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6847 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6848 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6849 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6850 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6851 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6852 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6853 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6854 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6855 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6856
6857 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6858 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6859 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6860 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6861 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6862 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6863 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6864 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6865 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6866 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6867 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6868 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6869 @end example
6870
6871 psoc6-specific commands
6872 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6873 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6874 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6875 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6876 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6877 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6878 @end deffn
6879
6880 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6881 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6882 by @command{flash banks}.
6883 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6884 @end deffn
6885 @end deffn
6886
6887 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6888 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6889 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6890 and SWD interface.
6891 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6892 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6893
6894 @example
6895 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6896 @end example
6897
6898 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6899
6900 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6901 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6902 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6903 @end deffn
6904
6905 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6906 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6907 @end deffn
6908 @end deffn
6909
6910 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6911 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6912 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6913 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6914 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6915
6916 @example
6917 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6918 @end example
6919
6920 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6921 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6922 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6923 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6924 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6925 disabled.
6926
6927 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6928 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6929 @quotation Warning
6930 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6931 applied to all of them.
6932 @end quotation
6933 @end deffn
6934 @end deffn
6935
6936 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6937 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6938 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6939 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6940 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6941
6942 @example
6943 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6944 @end example
6945
6946 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6947 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6948 the flash driver.
6949
6950 @example
6951 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6952 @end example
6953
6954 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6955 as per the following example.
6956 @example
6957 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6958 @end example
6959
6960 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6961
6962 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6963 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6964 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6965 @end deffn
6966
6967 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6968 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6969 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6970 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6971 @end deffn
6972
6973 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6974 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6975 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6976 @end deffn
6977
6978 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6979 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6980 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6981 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6982 @end deffn
6983
6984 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6985 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6986 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6987 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6988 @end deffn
6989
6990 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6991 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6992 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6993 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6994 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6995 @end deffn
6996 @end deffn
6997
6998 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6999 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7000 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7001 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7002 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7003
7004 @example
7005 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7006 @end example
7007
7008 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7009 as per the following example.
7010 @example
7011 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7012 @end example
7013
7014 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7015 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7016 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7017 @end deffn
7018
7019 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7020 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7021 the flash driver.
7022
7023 @example
7024 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7025 @end example
7026
7027 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7028
7029 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
7030 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7031 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7032 @end deffn
7033
7034 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
7035 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7036 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7037 @end deffn
7038
7039 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7040 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7041 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7042 @end deffn
7043
7044 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
7045 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7046 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7047 @end deffn
7048
7049 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7050 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7051 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7052 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7053 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7054 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7055 @end deffn
7056
7057 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7058 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7059 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7060 @end deffn
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
7064 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7065 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7066 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7067 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7068
7069 @example
7070 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7071 @end example
7072
7073 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7074 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7075 the flash driver.
7076
7077 @example
7078 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7079 @end example
7080
7081 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7082
7083 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
7084 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7085 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7086 @end deffn
7087
7088 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
7089 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7090 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7091 @end deffn
7092
7093 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7094 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7095 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7096 @end deffn
7097
7098 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7099 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7100 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7101 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7102 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7103
7104 Example usage:
7105 @example
7106 # read OPTSR_CUR
7107 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7108 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7109 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7110 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7111 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7112 @end example
7113 @end deffn
7114
7115 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7116 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7117 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7118 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7119 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7120 will be touched).
7121
7122 Example usage:
7123 @example
7124 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7125 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7126 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7127 @end example
7128 @end deffn
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
7132 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7133 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7134 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7135 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7136
7137 @example
7138 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7139 @end example
7140
7141 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7142 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7143 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7144 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7145 second bank.
7146
7147 @example
7148 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7149 @end example
7150
7151 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7152
7153 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
7154 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7155 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7156 @end deffn
7157
7158 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
7159 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7160 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7164 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7165 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7166 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7167 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7168 @end deffn
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
7172 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7173 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7174 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7175 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7176 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7177
7178 @example
7179 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7180 @end example
7181
7182 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7183 as per the following example.
7184 @example
7185 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7186 @end example
7187
7188 @deffn Command {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7189 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7190 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7191 @end deffn
7192
7193 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7194 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7195 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7196 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7197
7198 @example
7199 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7200 @end example
7201
7202 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7203
7204 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
7205 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7206 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7207 @end deffn
7208
7209 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
7210 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7211 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7215 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7216 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7217 @end deffn
7218
7219 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7220 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7221 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7222 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7223
7224 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7225 @example
7226 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7227 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7228 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7229 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7230 @end example
7231
7232 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7233 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7234 @end deffn
7235
7236 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7237 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7238 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7239 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7240 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7241
7242 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7243 @example
7244 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7245 @end example
7246
7247 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7248 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7249 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7250 @end deffn
7251
7252 @deffn Command {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7253 List the protected areas using WRP.
7254 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7255 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7256 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7257
7258 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7259 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7260 in single or dual-banks mode.
7261 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7262 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7263
7264 @end deffn
7265
7266 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7267 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7268 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7269 @end deffn
7270 @end deffn
7271
7272 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7273 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7274 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7275 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7276 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7277
7278 @example
7279 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7280 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7281 @end example
7282
7283 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7284 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7285 for the specified flash bank.
7286 @end deffn
7287 @end deffn
7288
7289 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7290 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7291 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7292 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7293 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7294
7295 @example
7296 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7297 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7298 @end example
7299
7300 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7301 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7302 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7303
7304 @itemize @bullet
7305 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7306 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7307 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7308 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7309 @end itemize
7310 @end deffn
7311
7312 @end deffn
7313
7314 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7315 @cindex str9xpec
7316
7317 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7318 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7319 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7320 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7321
7322 Here is some background info to help
7323 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7324 the str9:
7325 @enumerate
7326 @item
7327 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7328 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7329 @item
7330 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7331 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7332 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7333 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7334 @end enumerate
7335
7336 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7337 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7338 configured for flash bank 0.
7339 @example
7340 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7341 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7342 adapter assert srst
7343 # turn off target polling
7344 poll off
7345 # disable str9 core
7346 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7347 # read option bytes
7348 str9xpec options_read 0
7349 # re-enable str9 core
7350 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7351 poll on
7352 reset halt
7353 @end example
7354 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7355 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7356 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7357 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7358
7359 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7360
7361 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7362 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7363 @end deffn
7364
7365 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7366 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7367 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7368 @end deffn
7369
7370 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7371 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7372 erase the device.
7373 @end deffn
7374
7375 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7376 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7377 @end deffn
7378
7379 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7380 Configure str9 boot bank.
7381 @end deffn
7382
7383 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7384 Configure str9 lvd source.
7385 @end deffn
7386
7387 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7388 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7389 @end deffn
7390
7391 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7392 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7393 @end deffn
7394
7395 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7396 Read str9 option bytes.
7397 @end deffn
7398
7399 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7400 Write str9 option bytes.
7401 @end deffn
7402
7403 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7404 unlock str9 device.
7405 @end deffn
7406
7407 @end deffn
7408
7409 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7410 @cindex swm050
7411 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7412
7413 @example
7414 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7415 @end example
7416
7417 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7418
7419 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7420 Erases the entire flash bank.
7421 @end deffn
7422
7423 @end deffn
7424
7425
7426 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7427 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7428 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7429 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7430
7431 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7432
7433 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7434 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7435 @end deffn
7436
7437 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7438 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7439 @end deffn
7440
7441 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7442 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7443 the flash clock.
7444 @end deffn
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7448 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7449 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7450 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7451 correct bank config.
7452
7453 @example
7454 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7455 @end example
7456 @end deffn
7457
7458 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7459 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7460 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7461 @end deffn
7462
7463 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7464 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7465 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7466
7467 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7468
7469 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7470 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7471 @end deffn
7472
7473 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7474 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7475 @end deffn
7476
7477 @end deffn
7478
7479 @section NAND Flash Commands
7480 @cindex NAND
7481
7482 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7483 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7484 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7485
7486 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7487 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7488 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7489 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7490 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7491 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7492
7493 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7494 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7495 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7496 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7497 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7498 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7499 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7500 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7501 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7502 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7503
7504 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7505 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7506 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7507 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7508 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7509 every 512 bytes of data.
7510
7511 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7512 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7513 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7514 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7515 ECC mode is used.
7516
7517 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7518 @enumerate
7519 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7520 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7521 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7522 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7523 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7524 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7525 to access that device.
7526 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7527 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7528 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7529 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7530 de-brick a board.
7531 @end enumerate
7532
7533 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7534 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7535 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7536 are only 32 bits wide.
7537 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7538 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7539 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7540 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7541
7542 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7543 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7544 @cindex NAND configuration
7545
7546 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7547 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7548 OpenOCD has initialized.
7549
7550 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7551 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7552 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7553 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7554 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7555 they were a single (larger) device.
7556 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7557 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7558
7559 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7560 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7561 configuration files, not interactively.
7562
7563 @itemize @bullet
7564 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7565 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7566 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7567 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7568 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7569 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7570 commands to the NAND controller.
7571 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7572 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7573 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7574 for more information.
7575 @end itemize
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn Command {nand list}
7579 Prints a summary of each device declared
7580 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7581 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7582 @example
7583 > nand list
7584 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7585 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7586 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7587 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7588 >
7589 @end example
7590 @end deffn
7591
7592 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7593 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7594 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7595 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7596 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7597 it with most other NAND commands.
7598 @end deffn
7599
7600 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7601
7602 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7603 @cindex NAND reading
7604 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7605 starting at the specified offset.
7606 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7607
7608 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7609 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7610
7611 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7612 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7613 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7614
7615 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7616 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7617 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7618 method which handled that error correction.
7619
7620 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7621 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7622 @itemize @bullet
7623 @item no oob_* parameter
7624 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7625 @item @code{oob_raw}
7626 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7627 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7628 spare areas associated with each data page.
7629 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7630 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7631 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7632 @item @code{oob_only}
7633 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7634 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7635 spare areas associated with each data page.
7636 @end itemize
7637 @end deffn
7638
7639 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7640 @cindex NAND erasing
7641 @cindex NAND programming
7642 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7643 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7644 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7645 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7646 If those parameters are not specified,
7647 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7648 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7649
7650 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7651 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7652 block marker.
7653 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7654 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7655 @end deffn
7656
7657 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7658 @cindex NAND writing
7659 @cindex NAND programming
7660 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7661 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7662 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7663 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7664
7665 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7666 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7667
7668 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7669 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7670 past the end of the device.
7671 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7672 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7673 if that's being written.)
7674
7675 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7676 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7677 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7678
7679 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7680 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7681 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7682 @itemize @bullet
7683 @item no oob_* parameter
7684 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7685 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7686 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7687 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7688 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7689 @item @code{oob_only}
7690 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7691 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7692 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7693 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7694 @item @code{oob_raw}
7695 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7696 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7697 un-altered OOB.
7698 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7699 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7700 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7701 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7702 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7703 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7704 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7705 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7706 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7707 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7708 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7709 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7710 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7711 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7712 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7713 @end itemize
7714 @end deffn
7715
7716 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7717 @cindex NAND verification
7718 @cindex NAND programming
7719 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7720 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7721 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7722
7723 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7724 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7725
7726 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7727 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7728 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7729 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7730 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7731
7732 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7733 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7734 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7735
7736 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7737 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7738 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7739 be removed in a future release.
7740 @end deffn
7741
7742 @subsection Other NAND commands
7743 @cindex NAND other commands
7744
7745 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7746 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7747 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7748 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7749 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7750 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7751 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7752 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7753
7754 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7755 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7756 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7757 @end deffn
7758
7759 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7760 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7761 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7762 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7763 status for each block.
7764 @end deffn
7765
7766 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7767 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7768 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7769
7770 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7771 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7772 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7773 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7774 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7775
7776 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7777 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7778 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7779 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7780 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7781 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7782 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7786 @subsection NAND Driver List
7787 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7788 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7789 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7790
7791 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7792 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7793 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7794 address of the ECC controller.
7795 @example
7796 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7797 @end example
7798 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7799 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7800 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7801 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7802 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7803 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7804 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7805 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7806 @end deffn
7807 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7808 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7809 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7810 @end deffn
7811
7812 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7813 properly configured for input or output.
7814 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7815 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7816 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7817 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7818 @end deffn
7819 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7820 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7821 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7822 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7823 @end deffn
7824 @end deffn
7825
7826 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7827 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7828 chips from Texas Instruments.
7829 It takes three extra parameters:
7830 address of the NAND chip;
7831 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7832 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7833 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7834 @example
7835 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7836 @end example
7837 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7838 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7839 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7840 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7841 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7842 @end deffn
7843
7844 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7845 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7846 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7847 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7848 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7849 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7850 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7851 @end deffn
7852
7853 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7854 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7855 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7856 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7857 @end deffn
7858 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7859
7860 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7861 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7862 should work for this chip as well.
7863 @end deffn
7864
7865 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7866 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7867 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7868 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7869 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7870 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7871 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7872 @example
7873 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7874 @end example
7875 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7876 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7877 without parameter query status.
7878 @end deffn
7879 @end deffn
7880
7881 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7882 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7883 parameter: the address of the controller.
7884 @example
7885 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7886 @end example
7887 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7888 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7889 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7890 change any behavior.
7891 @end deffn
7892
7893 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7894 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7895 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7896 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7897 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7898 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7899 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7900 specialized commands.
7901 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7902 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7903 change any behavior.
7904 @end deffn
7905
7906 @node Flash Programming
7907 @chapter Flash Programming
7908
7909 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7910 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7911 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7912
7913 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7914 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7915
7916 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7917 @enumerate
7918 @item 'init' is executed.
7919 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7920 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7921 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7922 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7923 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7924 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7925 @end enumerate
7926
7927 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7928
7929 @example
7930 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7931 # are optional parameters
7932 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7933 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7934
7935 # binary files need the flash address passing
7936 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7937 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7938 @end example
7939
7940 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7941 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7942 @cindex PLD
7943 @cindex FPGA
7944
7945 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7946 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7947 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7948 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7949 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7950 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7951 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7952
7953 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7954
7955 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7956 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7957 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7958
7959 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7960 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7961
7962 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7963 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7964 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7965 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7966 behavior.
7967 @end deffn
7968
7969 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7970 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7971 @end deffn
7972
7973 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7974 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7975 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7979
7980 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7981 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7982 that particular type of PLD.
7983
7984 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7985 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7986 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7987
7988 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7989 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7990 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7991
7992 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7993 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7994 for FPGA @var{num}.
7995 @end deffn
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @node General Commands
7999 @chapter General Commands
8000 @cindex commands
8001
8002 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8003 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8004 commands are documented elsewhere.
8005
8006 Intent:
8007 @itemize @bullet
8008 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8009 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8010 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8011 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8012
8013 @item @b{From the human}
8014 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8015 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8016
8017 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8018 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8019 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8020
8021 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8022 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8023 port is 5555.
8024 @end itemize
8025
8026
8027 @section Server Commands
8028
8029 @deffn {Command} exit
8030 Exits the current telnet session.
8031 @end deffn
8032
8033 @deffn {Command} help [string]
8034 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8035 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8036 Not every command provides helptext.
8037
8038 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8039 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8040 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8041 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
8045 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8046 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8047 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8048 Useful in connection with script files
8049 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8050 @end deffn
8051
8052 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
8053 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8054 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8055 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8056
8057 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8058 @example
8059 # redefine shutdown
8060 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8061 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8062 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8063 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8064 original_shutdown
8065 @}
8066 @end example
8067 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8068 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8069 @end deffn
8070
8071 @anchor{debuglevel}
8072 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
8073 @cindex message level
8074 Display debug level.
8075 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8076 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8077 Level 0 is error messages only;
8078 level 1 adds warnings;
8079 level 2 adds informational messages;
8080 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8081 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8082 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8083 the command line along with the location of that log
8084 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8085 @xref{Running}.
8086 @end deffn
8087
8088 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
8089 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8090 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8091 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8092 @example
8093 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8094 @end example
8095 @end deffn
8096
8097 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
8098 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8099 the default log output channel is stderr.
8100 @end deffn
8101
8102 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
8103 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8104 @end deffn
8105
8106 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
8107 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8108 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8109 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8110 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8111 @end deffn
8112
8113 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8114 @section Target State handling
8115 @cindex reset
8116 @cindex halt
8117 @cindex target initialization
8118
8119 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8120 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8121 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8122 a current target which is used to perform the
8123 various operations. The current target may be changed
8124 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8125 target which should become current.
8126
8127 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8128 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8129 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8130 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8131 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8132
8133 @emph{With no arguments}:
8134 list all available registers for the current target,
8135 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8136 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8137 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8138 are flagged as such.
8139
8140 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8141 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8142 bypassing any internal cache.
8143
8144 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8145 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8146 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8147 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8148 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8149 relevant module will flush such values.
8150
8151 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8152 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8153
8154 @example
8155 > reg
8156 ===== ARM registers
8157 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8158 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8159 (2) r2 (/32)
8160 ...
8161 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8162 >
8163 @end example
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn Command halt [ms]
8167 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
8168 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8169 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8170 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8171 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8172 (and enter debug mode).
8173 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8174
8175 @quotation Warning
8176 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8177 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8178 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8179 power mode by gating the core clock;
8180 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8181
8182 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8183 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8184 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8185 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8186 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8187 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8188
8189 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8190 work with a JTAG debugger.
8191 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8192 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8193 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8194 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8195 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8196 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8197 @end quotation
8198
8199 @end deffn
8200
8201 @deffn Command resume [address]
8202 Resume the target at its current code position,
8203 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8204 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8205 @end deffn
8206
8207 @deffn Command step [address]
8208 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8209 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8210 @end deffn
8211
8212 @anchor{resetcommand}
8213 @deffn Command reset
8214 @deffnx Command {reset run}
8215 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
8216 @deffnx Command {reset init}
8217 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8218 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8219 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8220
8221 The optional parameter specifies what should
8222 happen after the reset.
8223 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8224 The other options will not work on all systems.
8225 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8226
8227 @itemize @minus
8228 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8229 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8230 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8231 @end itemize
8232 @end deffn
8233
8234 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8235 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8236 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8237 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8238 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8239 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8240 state.
8241 @end deffn
8242
8243 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8244 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8245 Set values of reset signals.
8246 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8247 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8248 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8249 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8250
8251 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8252 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8253 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8254 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8255 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8256 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8257 the signal will not be modified.
8258
8259 @quotation Note
8260 TRST is specially handled.
8261 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8262 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8263 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8264 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8265 instead of the TRST signal.
8266 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8267 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8268 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8269 with handlers for that event.
8270 @end quotation
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8274 @section Memory access commands
8275 @cindex memory access
8276
8277 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8278 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8279 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8280 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8281
8282 @enumerate
8283 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8284 to change the current target.
8285 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8286 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8287 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8288 @end enumerate
8289
8290 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8291 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8292 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8293 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8294 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8295 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8296 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8297 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8298 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8299 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8300 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8301 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8302 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8303 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8304 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8305 @end deffn
8306
8307 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8308 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8309 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8310 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8311 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8312 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8313 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8314 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8315 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8316 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8317 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8318 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8319 @end deffn
8320
8321 @anchor{imageaccess}
8322 @section Image loading commands
8323 @cindex image loading
8324 @cindex image dumping
8325
8326 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8327 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8328 binary file named @var{filename}.
8329 @end deffn
8330
8331 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8332 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8333 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8334 @end deffn
8335
8336 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8337 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8338 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8339 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8340 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8341 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8342 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8343 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8344 separately.
8345 @end deffn
8346
8347 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8348 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8349 The file format may optionally be specified
8350 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8351 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8352 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8353 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8354 @example
8355 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8356 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8357 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8358 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8359 $address $length
8360 @}
8361 @end example
8362 @end deffn
8363
8364 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8365 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8366 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8367 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8368 The file format may optionally be specified
8369 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8370 @end deffn
8371
8372 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8373 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8374 The file format may optionally be specified
8375 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8376 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8377 @end deffn
8378
8379 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8380 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8381 The file format may optionally be specified
8382 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8383 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8384 @end deffn
8385
8386
8387 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8388 @cindex breakpoint
8389 @cindex watchpoint
8390
8391 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8392 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8393 watchpoints.
8394 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8395
8396 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8397 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8398 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8399 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8400 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8401 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8402
8403 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8404 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8405 @end deffn
8406
8407 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8408 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8412 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8413 @end deffn
8414
8415 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8416 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8417 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8418 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8419 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8420 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8421 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8422 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8423 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8424 @end deffn
8425
8426
8427 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8428
8429 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8430 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8431 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8432 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8433 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8434 running, can be used.
8435 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8436 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8437 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8438
8439 @quotation Note
8440 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8441 @end quotation
8442
8443 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8444 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8445 communication, respectively.
8446
8447 @quotation Note
8448 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8449 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8450 example.
8451 @end quotation
8452
8453 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8454 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8455 of TCP/IP connections.
8456
8457 @deffn Command {rtt setup} address size ID
8458 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8459 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8460 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8461 @var{size} bytes.
8462 @end deffn
8463
8464 @deffn Command {rtt start}
8465 Start RTT.
8466 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8467 @end deffn
8468
8469 @deffn Command {rtt stop}
8470 Stop RTT.
8471 @end deffn
8472
8473 @deffn Command {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8474 Display the polling interval.
8475 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8476 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8477 checked for new data.
8478 @end deffn
8479
8480 @deffn Command {rtt channels}
8481 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8482 @end deffn
8483
8484 @deffn Command {rtt channellist}
8485 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8486 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @deffn Command {rtt server start} port channel
8490 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8491 @end deffn
8492
8493 @deffn Command {rtt server stop} port
8494 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8495 @end deffn
8496
8497 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8498 on the target device.
8499
8500 @example
8501 resume
8502
8503 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8504 rtt start
8505
8506 rtt server start 9090 0
8507 @end example
8508
8509 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8510 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8511 TCP/IP port 9090.
8512
8513
8514 @section Misc Commands
8515
8516 @cindex profiling
8517 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8518 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8519 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8520 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8521 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8522 limit the address range.
8523 @end deffn
8524
8525 @deffn Command {version}
8526 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8527 @end deffn
8528
8529 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8530 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8531 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8532 @end deffn
8533
8534 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8535 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8536 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8537 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8538
8539 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8540 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8541 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8542 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8543
8544 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8545 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8546 @cindex tracing
8547 @cindex ETM
8548 @cindex ETB
8549
8550 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8551 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8552 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8553
8554 @itemize
8555 @item
8556 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8557 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8558 supports such an interface.
8559 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8560 and trace port support.)
8561 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8562 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8563 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8564 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8565 in the board-specific configuration file.
8566 @item
8567 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8568 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8569 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8570 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8571 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8572 @end itemize
8573
8574 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8575
8576 @quotation Issues
8577 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8578 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8579
8580 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8581 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8582 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8583 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8584 dummy trace port driver}.
8585
8586 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8587 as well as tracing only during specific states
8588 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8589
8590 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8591 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8592 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8593 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8594 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8595
8596 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8597 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8598 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8599 this original style of JTAG access.
8600 @end quotation
8601
8602 @subsection ETM Configuration
8603 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8604
8605 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8606 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8607 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8608
8609 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8610 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8611 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8612 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8613 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8614 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8615 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8616 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8617 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8618
8619 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8620 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8621 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8622
8623 @quotation Warning
8624 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8625 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8626 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8627 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8628 @end quotation
8629
8630 @quotation Note
8631 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8632 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8633 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8634 what CPU activities are traced.
8635 @end quotation
8636 @end deffn
8637
8638 @deffn Command {etm info}
8639 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8640 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8641 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8642 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8643 @end deffn
8644
8645 @deffn Command {etm status}
8646 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8647 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8648 Did trace data overflow?
8649 Was it triggered?
8650 @end deffn
8651
8652 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8653 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8654 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8655 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8656 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8657
8658 @itemize
8659 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8660 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8661 The value is one of
8662 @option{none} (save nothing),
8663 @option{data} (save data),
8664 @option{address} (save addresses),
8665 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8666 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8667 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8668 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8669 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8670 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8671 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8672 trace stream without an image of the code.
8673 @end itemize
8674 @end deffn
8675
8676 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8677 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8678 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8679 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8680 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8681
8682 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8683 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8684 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8685 @end deffn
8686
8687 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8688
8689 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8690 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8691 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8692
8693 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8694 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8695 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8696 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8697 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8698 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8699 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8700
8701 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8702
8703 @itemize
8704 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8705 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8706 for instruction access within that function's body.
8707 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8708 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8709 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8710 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8711 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8712 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8713 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8714 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8715 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8716 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8717 @item @emph{... more}
8718 @end itemize
8719
8720 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8721 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8722
8723 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8724 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8725 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8726 @end deffn
8727
8728 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8729 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8730 @end deffn
8731
8732 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8733 Opens an image file.
8734 @end deffn
8735
8736 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8737 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8738 @end deffn
8739
8740 @deffn Command {etm start}
8741 Starts trace data collection.
8742 @end deffn
8743
8744 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8745 Stops trace data collection.
8746 @end deffn
8747
8748 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8749 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8750
8751 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8752
8753 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8754 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8755 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8756 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8757 any trace data collection.}
8758 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8759 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8760 @end deffn
8761 @end deffn
8762
8763 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8764 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8765 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8766 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8767 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8768 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8769 @end deffn
8770 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8771 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8772 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8773 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8774 trace trigger becomes active.
8775
8776 @itemize
8777 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8778 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8779 afterwards.
8780 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8781 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8782 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8783 what caused that event to happen.
8784 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8785 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8786 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8787 how the event caused trouble.
8788 @end itemize
8789 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8790 @end deffn
8791
8792 @end deffn
8793
8794 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8795 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8796 @cindex CTI
8797
8798 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8799 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8800 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8801 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8802 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8803 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8804
8805 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8806 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8807 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8808 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8809 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8810 including additional configuration.
8811 @end deffn
8812
8813 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8814 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8815 @end deffn
8816
8817 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8818 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8819 @end deffn
8820
8821 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8822 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8823 @end deffn
8824
8825 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8826 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8827 @end deffn
8828
8829 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8830 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8831 @end deffn
8832
8833 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8834 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8835 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8836 @end deffn
8837
8838 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8839 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8840 of the CTI.
8841 @end deffn
8842
8843 @deffn Command {cti names}
8844 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8845 useful in TCL scripting.
8846 @end deffn
8847
8848 @section Generic ARM
8849 @cindex ARM
8850
8851 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8852 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8853 commands that may be available.
8854
8855 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8856 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8857 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8858 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8859 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8860 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8861 @end deffn
8862
8863 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8864 @cindex disassemble
8865 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8866 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8867 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8868 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8869 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8870 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8871 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8872
8873 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8874 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8875 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8876 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8877 with a handful of exceptions.
8878 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8879 @end deffn
8880
8881 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8882 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8883 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8884 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8885 and using the MCR instruction.
8886 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8887 an ARM register.)
8888 @end deffn
8889
8890 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8891 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8892 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8893 and the MRC instruction.
8894 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8895 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8896 an ARM register.)
8897 @end deffn
8898
8899 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8900 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8901 core mode if necessary.
8902 @end deffn
8903
8904 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8905 @cindex ARM semihosting
8906 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8907
8908 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8909 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8910 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8911 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8912 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8913 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8914 @end deffn
8915
8916 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8917 @cindex ARM semihosting
8918 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8919
8920 @example
8921 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8922 @end example
8923
8924 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8925 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8926 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8927 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8928 @end deffn
8929
8930 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8931 @cindex ARM semihosting
8932 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8933 status.
8934
8935 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8936 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8937 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8938 debugger.
8939 @end deffn
8940
8941 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8942 @cindex ARM semihosting
8943 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8944
8945 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8946 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8947 the value returned by the target.
8948
8949 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8950 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8951 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8952 encountering a break.
8953
8954 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8955 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8956 to the debugger.
8957 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8958 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8959 request or equivalent").
8960
8961 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8962 this option (default: disabled).
8963 @end deffn
8964
8965 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8966 @cindex ARMv4
8967 @cindex ARMv5
8968
8969 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8970 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8971 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8972 variant.
8973
8974 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8975 @cindex ARM7
8976 @cindex ARM9
8977
8978 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8979 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8980 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8981 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8982
8983 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8984 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8985 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8986 instead of breakpoints.
8987 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8988
8989 This should be
8990 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8991 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8992 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8993 @end deffn
8994
8995 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8996 @cindex DCC
8997 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8998 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8999 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9000
9001 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9002 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9003 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9004 @end deffn
9005
9006 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9007 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9008 that don't check completion of the operation.
9009 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9010
9011 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9012 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9013 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9014 @end deffn
9015
9016 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9017 @cindex ARM9
9018
9019 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9020 integer processors.
9021 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9022
9023 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9024 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9025 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9026 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9027
9028 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9029 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9030 @cindex vector_catch
9031 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9032 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9033 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9034 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9035 to those hardware vectors.
9036
9037 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9038 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9039 vector catch hardware to intercept
9040 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9041 @option{none} of them,
9042 or a list with one or more of the following:
9043 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9044 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9045 @end deffn
9046
9047 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9048 @cindex ARM920T
9049
9050 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9051 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9052 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9053 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9054 and ARM9 commands.
9055
9056 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
9057 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9058 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9059 @end deffn
9060
9061 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9062 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9063 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9064 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9065 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9066 (Not all registers can be written.)
9067 @end deffn
9068
9069 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
9070 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9071 @end deffn
9072
9073 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9074 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9075 @end deffn
9076
9077 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9078 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9079
9080 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9081 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9082 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9083 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9084 and ARM9 commands.
9085
9086 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9087 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9088
9089 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
9090 Print information about the caches found.
9091 @end deffn
9092
9093 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9094 @cindex ARM966E
9095
9096 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9097 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9098 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9099 and ARM9 commands.
9100
9101 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9102 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9103 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9104 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9105 ARM966E-S TRM.
9106 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9107 as required for BIST support.
9108 @end deffn
9109
9110 @subsection XScale specific commands
9111 @cindex XScale
9112
9113 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9114
9115 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9116 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9117 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9118 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9119 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9120 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9121 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9122
9123 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9124 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9125 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9126 the mini-IC.
9127
9128 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9129 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9130 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9131 code layout in memory:
9132 @example
9133 _vectors:
9134 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9135 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9136 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9137 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9138 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9139 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9140 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9141 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9142 .org 0x100
9143 .long real_reset_vector
9144 .long real_ui_handler
9145 .long real_swi_handler
9146 .long real_pf_abort
9147 .long real_data_abort
9148 .long 0 /* unused */
9149 .long real_irq_handler
9150 .long real_fiq_handler
9151 @end example
9152
9153 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9154 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9155 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9156 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9157 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9158 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9159 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9160 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9161 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9162 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9163 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9164 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9165 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9166 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9167 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9168 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9169 software.
9170
9171 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9172 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9173 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9174 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9175
9176 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9177 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9178 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9179 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9180 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9181 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9182 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9183 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9184 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9185
9186 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9187 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9188
9189 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
9190 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9191 @end deffn
9192
9193 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9194 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9195 @end deffn
9196
9197 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
9198 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9199 @end deffn
9200
9201 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9202 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9203 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9204 @end deffn
9205
9206 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9207 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9208 @end deffn
9209
9210 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9211 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9212 @end deffn
9213
9214 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9215 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9216 @end deffn
9217
9218 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9219 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9220 @end deffn
9221
9222 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9223 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9224 @end deffn
9225
9226 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9227 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9228 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9229 and modifying how it is emptied.
9230 @end deffn
9231
9232 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9233 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9234 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9235 The image @var{type} may be one of
9236 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9237 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9238 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9239 @end deffn
9240
9241 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9242 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9243 @cindex vector_catch
9244 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9245 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9246
9247 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9248 @example
9249 0x01 Trap Reset
9250 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9251 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9252 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9253 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9254 0x20 reserved
9255 0x40 Trap IRQ
9256 0x80 Trap FIQ
9257 @end example
9258 @end deffn
9259
9260 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9261 @cindex vector_table
9262
9263 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9264 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9265 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9266 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9267 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9268
9269 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9270
9271 @end deffn
9272
9273 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9274 @cindex ARMv6
9275
9276 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9277 @cindex ARM11
9278
9279 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9280 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9281 which is enabled by default.
9282 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9283 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9284 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9285 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9286 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9287 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9291 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9292 which is enabled by default.
9293 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9294 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9295 @end deffn
9296
9297 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9298 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9299 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9300 they are disabled by default.
9301 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9302 @end deffn
9303
9304 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9305 @cindex vector_catch
9306 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9307 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9308 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9309
9310 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9311 for certain hardware events.
9312 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9313 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9314 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9315 @end deffn
9316
9317 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9318 @cindex ARMv7
9319 @cindex ARMv8
9320
9321 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9322 @cindex Cortex-A
9323
9324 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9325 display information about target caches
9326 @end deffn
9327
9328 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9329 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9330 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9331 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9332 Defaults to 'off'.
9333 @end deffn
9334
9335 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9336 Initialize core debug
9337 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9338 @end deffn
9339
9340 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9341 Display/set the current SMP mode
9342 @end deffn
9343
9344 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9345 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9346 @end deffn
9347
9348 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9349 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9350 @end deffn
9351
9352 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9353 configure l2x cache
9354 @end deffn
9355
9356 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9357 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9358 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9359 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9360 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9361 @end deffn
9362
9363 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9364 @cindex Cortex-R
9365
9366 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9367 Initialize core debug
9368 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9369 @end deffn
9370
9371 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9372 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9373 @end deffn
9374
9375
9376 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9377 @cindex tracing
9378 @cindex SWO
9379 @cindex SWV
9380 @cindex TPIU
9381
9382 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9383 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9384 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9385 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9386
9387 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9388 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9389 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9390 which causes quite some confusion.
9391 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9392 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9393
9394 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9395 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9396 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9397
9398 @deffn Command {swo} ...
9399 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9400 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9401 @end deffn
9402
9403 @deffn Command {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9404 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9405 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9406 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9407
9408 @itemize @bullet
9409 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9410 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9411 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9412 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9413
9414 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9415 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9416 @end itemize
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @deffn Command {tpiu names}
9420 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9421 @end deffn
9422
9423 @deffn Command {tpiu init}
9424 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9425 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9426 at any time after the initialization, too.
9427 @end deffn
9428
9429 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9430 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9431 individually queried, to return its current value.
9432 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9433 @end deffn
9434
9435 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9436 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9437 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9438 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9439
9440 @itemize @bullet
9441 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9442 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9443
9444 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9445 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9446
9447 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9448 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9449
9450 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9451 protocol used for trace data:
9452 @itemize @minus
9453 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9454 data bits (default);
9455 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9456 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9457 @end itemize
9458
9459 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9460 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9461 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9462 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9463 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9464 of the TPIU.
9465
9466 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9467 the destination of the trace data:
9468 @itemize @minus
9469 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9470 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9471 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9472 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9473 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9474 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9475 each connected client;
9476 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9477 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9478 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9479 @end itemize
9480
9481 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9482 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9483 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9484 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9485
9486 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9487 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9488 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9489 maximum supported rate automatically.
9490
9491 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9492 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9493 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9494
9495 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9496 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9497 default value is @var{0}.
9498 @end itemize
9499 @end deffn
9500
9501 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name enable}
9502 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9503 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9504 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9505 data.
9506 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9507 after the @command{init}.
9508 @end deffn
9509
9510 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name disable}
9511 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9512 @end deffn
9513
9514
9515
9516 Example usage:
9517 @enumerate
9518 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9519 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9520 enough to:
9521 @example
9522 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9523 ...
9524 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9525 ...
9526 @end example
9527 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9528 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9529 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9530 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9531 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9532 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9533 @example
9534 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9535 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9536 @end example
9537 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9538 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9539 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9540 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9541 @example
9542 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9543 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9544 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9545 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9546 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9547 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9548 @end example
9549 @end enumerate
9550
9551 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9552 @cindex tracing
9553 @cindex SWO
9554 @cindex SWV
9555 @cindex ITM
9556 @cindex ETM
9557
9558 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9559 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9560 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9561 @end deffn
9562
9563 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9564 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9565 @end deffn
9566
9567 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9568 @cindex Cortex-M
9569
9570 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9571 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9572
9573 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9574 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9575 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9576 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9577 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9578 the step command leaves with the core running.
9579
9580 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9581 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9582 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9583 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9584
9585 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9586 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9587 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9588 does.
9589
9590 Default is @option{auto}.
9591 @end deffn
9592
9593 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9594 @cindex vector_catch
9595 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9596 for certain hardware events.
9597
9598 Parameters request interception of
9599 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9600 @option{none} of them,
9601 or one or more of the following:
9602 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9603 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9604 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9605 @option{irq_err},
9606 @option{state_err},
9607 @option{chk_err}, or
9608 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9609 @option{reset}.
9610 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9611 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9612 are mapped to HardFault.
9613 UsageFault checks for
9614 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9615 must also be explicitly enabled.
9616
9617 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9618 @end deffn
9619
9620 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9621 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9622 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9623
9624 @itemize @minus
9625 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9626 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9627 @end itemize
9628
9629 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9630 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9631 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9632 to manually reset the peripherals.
9633 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9634
9635 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9636 instead.
9637 @end deffn
9638
9639 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9640 @cindex ARMv8-A
9641 @cindex aarch64
9642
9643 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9644 Display information about target caches
9645 @end deffn
9646
9647 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9648 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9649 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9650 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9651 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9652 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9653 @end deffn
9654
9655 @deffn Command {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9656 @cindex disassemble
9657 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9658 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9659 @end deffn
9660
9661 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9662 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9663 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9664 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9665 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9666 @end deffn
9667
9668 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9669 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9670 @option{on}.
9671 @end deffn
9672
9673 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9674 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9675 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9676 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9677 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9678 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9679 @end deffn
9680
9681 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9682
9683 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9684 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9685
9686 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9687
9688 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9689 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9690 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9691 @end deffn
9692
9693 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9694 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9695 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9696 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9697 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9698 @end deffn
9699
9700 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9701
9702 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9703 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9704 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9705 @end deffn
9706
9707 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9708
9709 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9710 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9711 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9712 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9713 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9714 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9715 can be collected.
9716
9717 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9718 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9719 tooling.
9720
9721 @quotation Issues
9722 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9723 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9724 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9725 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9726
9727 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9728 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9729 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9730 software operation on the CPU.
9731 @end quotation
9732
9733 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9734 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9735 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9736 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9737 @end deffn
9738
9739 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9740 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9741 @end deffn
9742
9743 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9744 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9745 control is disabled.
9746 @end deffn
9747
9748 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9749 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9750 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9751 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9752
9753 Supported trace formats:
9754 @itemize
9755 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9756 timing to be determined.
9757 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9758 addresses.
9759 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9760 @end itemize
9761 @end deffn
9762
9763 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9764 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9765 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9766 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9767
9768 Supported conditions:
9769 @itemize
9770 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9771 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9772 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9773 instruction matches start data and mask.
9774 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9775 instruction matches start data and mask.
9776 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9777 data and mask.
9778 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9779 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9780 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9781 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9782 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9783 @end itemize
9784 @end deffn
9785
9786 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9787 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9788 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9789 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9790
9791 Supported conditions:
9792 @itemize
9793 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9794 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9795 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9796 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9797 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9798 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9799 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9800 data and mask.
9801 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9802 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9803 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9804 @end itemize
9805 @end deffn
9806
9807 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9808 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9809
9810 Supported triggers:
9811 @itemize
9812 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9813 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9814 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9815 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9816 collection.
9817 @end itemize
9818 @end deffn
9819
9820 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9821
9822 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9823 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9824 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9825 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9826 @end deffn
9827
9828 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9829 Display trace configuration.
9830 @end deffn
9831
9832 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9833 Display trace collection status.
9834 @end deffn
9835
9836 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9837 Start manual trace collection.
9838 @end deffn
9839
9840 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9841 Stop manual trace collection.
9842 @end deffn
9843
9844 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9845 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9846 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9847 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9848 @option{size} options using DMA.
9849 @end deffn
9850
9851 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9852 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9853 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9854 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9855 @option{size} options using DMA.
9856 @end deffn
9857
9858 @section Intel Architecture
9859
9860 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9861 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9862 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9863 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9864 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9865 @itemize
9866 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9867 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9868 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9869 @end itemize
9870
9871 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9872 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9873 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9874
9875 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9876 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9877 @end deffn
9878
9879 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9880 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9881 @end deffn
9882
9883 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9884 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9885 @end deffn
9886
9887 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9888 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9889 @end deffn
9890
9891 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9892 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9893 @end deffn
9894
9895 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9896 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9897 @end deffn
9898
9899 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9900
9901 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9902 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9903
9904 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9905 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9906 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9907 @end deffn
9908 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9909 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9910
9911 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9912
9913 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9914 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9915 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9916 @end deffn
9917
9918 @subsection Registers commands
9919 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9920 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9921 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9922
9923 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9924
9925 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9926 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9927 and "timer" groups.
9928
9929 @emph{example:}
9930 @example
9931 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9932 @end example
9933
9934
9935 @end deffn
9936 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9937 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9938
9939 @emph{group} can be "system",
9940 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9941 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9942 @end deffn
9943
9944 @section RISC-V Architecture
9945
9946 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9947 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9948 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9949 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9950 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9951 implement version 0.11.
9952
9953 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9954
9955 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9956 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9957 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9958
9959 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9960
9961 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9962 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9963 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9964
9965 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9966 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9967 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9968 CSRs.
9969 @end deffn
9970
9971 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9972 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9973 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9974 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9975 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9976 This command must be executed before `init`.
9977 @end deffn
9978
9979 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9980 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9981 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9982 @end deffn
9983
9984 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9985 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9986 deasserted.
9987 @end deffn
9988
9989 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9990 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9991 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9992 @end deffn
9993
9994 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9995 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
9996 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9997 @end deffn
9998
9999 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10000 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10001 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10002 on physical memory.
10003 @end deffn
10004
10005 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10006 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10007 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10008 performed on physical memory.
10009 @end deffn
10010
10011 @deffn Command {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10012 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10013 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10014 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10015 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10016 race condition problem in your code.
10017
10018 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10019 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10020 @end deffn
10021
10022 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10023 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10024 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10025 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10026 values.
10027
10028 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10029 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10030 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10031 @end deffn
10032
10033 @deffn Command {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10034 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10035 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10036 @end deffn
10037
10038 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10039 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10040 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10041 @end deffn
10042
10043 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10044 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10045 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10049 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10050 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10051 @end deffn
10052
10053 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10054
10055 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10056 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10057 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10058 @example
10059 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10060 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10061 @end example
10062
10063 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
10064 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10065 @end deffn
10066
10067 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
10068 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10069 @end deffn
10070
10071 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10072
10073 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10074 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10075
10076 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read} address
10077 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10078 @end deffn
10079
10080 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
10081 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10082 @end deffn
10083
10084 @section ARC Architecture
10085 @cindex ARC
10086
10087 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10088 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10089 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10090 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10091 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10092 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10093 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10094 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10095 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10096 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10097 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10098 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10099 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10100 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10101 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10102
10103
10104 @subsection General ARC commands
10105
10106 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10107
10108 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10109 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10110 arguments:
10111
10112 @itemize @bullet
10113
10114 @item @code{-name} name
10115 @*Name of a register.
10116
10117 @item @code{-num} number
10118 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10119
10120 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10121 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10122
10123 @end itemize
10124
10125 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10126
10127 @itemize @bullet
10128
10129 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10130 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10131 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10132 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10133 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10134 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10135
10136 @item @code{-core}
10137 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10138 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10139 spaces.
10140
10141 @item @code{-bcr}
10142 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10143 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10144 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10145 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10146 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10147
10148 @item @code{-type} type_name
10149 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10150 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10151
10152 @item @code{-g}
10153 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10154 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10155 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10156 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10157 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10158
10159 @end itemize
10160
10161 @end deffn
10162
10163 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10164 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10165 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10166 @end deffn
10167
10168 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10169 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10170 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10171 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10172 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10173 startbit endbit}.
10174 @end deffn
10175
10176 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10177 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10178 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
10179 @end deffn
10180
10181 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10182 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10183 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10184 @end deffn
10185
10186 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10187
10188 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10189 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10190 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10191 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10192
10193 @end deffn
10194
10195 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10196 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10197 registers.
10198 @end deffn
10199
10200 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10201 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10202 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10203 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10204
10205 @end deffn
10206
10207 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10208 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10209 registers.
10210 @end deffn
10211
10212 @section STM8 Architecture
10213 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10214 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10215
10216 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10217 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10218
10219 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10220 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10221 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10222 @cindex tracing
10223 @cindex libdcc
10224 @cindex DCC
10225 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10226 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10227 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10228 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10229
10230 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10231 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10232 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10233 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10234 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10235 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10236
10237 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10238 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10239 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10240 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10241 The target being debugged may
10242 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10243 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10244 each supported by a command:
10245
10246 @itemize
10247 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10248 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10249 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10250 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10251
10252 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10253 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10254 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10255
10256 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10257 and then displayed at any time.
10258 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10259
10260 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10261 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10262 @end itemize
10263
10264 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10265 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10266 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10267 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10268 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10269 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10270 does the same thing.
10271
10272 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10273 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10274 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10275 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10276 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10277
10278 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10279 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10280 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10281 @end deffn
10282
10283 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10284 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10285 in the order they triggered.
10286 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10287 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10288 history records.
10289 @end deffn
10290
10291 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10292 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10293 they have been triggered.
10294 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10295 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10296 and associates it with that identifier.
10297
10298 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10299 are not related except by this command.
10300 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10301 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10302 @end deffn
10303
10304
10305 @node JTAG Commands
10306 @chapter JTAG Commands
10307 @cindex JTAG Commands
10308 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10309 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10310 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10311 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10312 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10313
10314 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10315 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10316
10317 @itemize @bullet
10318 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10319 devices such as a CPUs.
10320 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10321 standard state machine (in parallel)
10322 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10323 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10324 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10325 while the reading previous ones.
10326 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10327 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10328 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10329 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10330 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10331 registers.
10332 @end itemize
10333
10334 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10335
10336 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10337 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10338 the order of TAP state transitions.
10339 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10340 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10341 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10342 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10343 these commands are not available.
10344
10345 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10346 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10347 that specify the entire register.
10348 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10349 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10350 The return value holds the original value of each
10351 of those fields.
10352
10353 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10354 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10355 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10356 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10357 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10358
10359 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10360 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10361
10362 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10363 in that state.
10364 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10365 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10366 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10367
10368 @quotation Warning
10369 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10370 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10371 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10372 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10373 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10374 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10375 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10376 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10377 @end quotation
10378 @end deffn
10379
10380 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10381 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10382 This may be used for performance tuning.
10383
10384 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10385 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10386 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10387 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10388 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10389 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10390 @end deffn
10391
10392 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10393 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10394 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10395 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10396 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10397 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10398
10399 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10400 in that state.
10401 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10402 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10403 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10404
10405 @quotation Note
10406 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10407 register values, unlike data register values.
10408 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10409 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10410 @end quotation
10411 @end deffn
10412
10413 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10414 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10415 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10416 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10417 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10418 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10419 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10420 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10421 The final state must also be stable.
10422 @end deffn
10423
10424 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10425 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10426 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10427 Instructions often need some time
10428 to execute before they take effect.
10429 @end deffn
10430
10431 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10432 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10433
10434 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10435 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10436 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10437 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10438 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10439 @end deffn
10440
10441 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10442 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10443 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10444 must also be enabled.
10445 Default is enabled.
10446 @end deffn
10447
10448 @section TAP state names
10449 @cindex TAP state names
10450
10451 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10452 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10453 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10454 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10455
10456 @itemize @bullet
10457 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10458 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10459 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10460 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10461 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10462 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10463 through the data register
10464 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10465 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10466 for update or more shifting
10467 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10468 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10469 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10470 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10471 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10472 through the instruction register
10473 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10474 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10475 for update or more shifting
10476 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10477 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10478 @end itemize
10479
10480 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10481 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10482 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10483 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10484
10485 @itemize @bullet
10486 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10487 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10488 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10489 may not be as expected.
10490 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10491 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10492 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10493 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10494 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10495 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10496 @end itemize
10497
10498 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10499 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10500
10501 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10502 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10503 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10504 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10505
10506 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10507 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10508 @cindex SVF
10509
10510 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10511 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10512 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10513 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10514
10515 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10516 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10517 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10518 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10519
10520 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10521 affect their semantics.
10522
10523 Command options:
10524 @itemize @minus
10525 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10526 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10527 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10528 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10529 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10530 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10531 on the real interface;
10532 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10533 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10534 errors.
10535 @end itemize
10536 @end deffn
10537
10538 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10539 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10540 @cindex XSVF
10541
10542 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10543 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10544 Xilinx devices.
10545 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10546 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10547
10548 @quotation Important
10549 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10550 @end quotation
10551
10552 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10553 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10554 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10555 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10556 that TAP.
10557 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10558 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10559 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10560 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10561 @end deffn
10562
10563 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10564 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10565 after building the software.
10566 You may find them useful:
10567
10568 @itemize
10569 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10570 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10571 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10572 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10573 @end itemize
10574
10575 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10576 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10577 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10578 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10579 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10580 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10581 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10582
10583
10584 @node Utility Commands
10585 @chapter Utility Commands
10586 @cindex Utility Commands
10587
10588 @section RAM testing
10589 @cindex RAM testing
10590
10591 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10592 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10593 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10594 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10595 hardware problems.
10596
10597 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10598 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10599 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10600 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10601
10602 Load the memory testing functions with
10603
10604 @example
10605 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10606 @end example
10607
10608 to get access to the following facilities:
10609
10610 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10611 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10612 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10613 @end deffn
10614
10615 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10616 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10617 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10618 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10619 @end deffn
10620
10621 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10622 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10623 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10624 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10625 @end deffn
10626
10627 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10628 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10629 @end deffn
10630
10631 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10632 @cindex Firmware recovery
10633
10634 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10635 devices recovery with JTAG.
10636
10637 For quickstart instructions run:
10638 @example
10639 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10640 @end example
10641
10642 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10643 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10644 @cindex GDB
10645 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10646 to debug remote targets.
10647 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10648
10649 @itemize
10650 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10651 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10652 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10653 as shown in this chapter.
10654 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10655 that also will probably need to be configured.
10656 @end itemize
10657
10658 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10659 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10660 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10661 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10662 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10663 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10664
10665 @section Connecting to GDB
10666 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10667 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10668 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10669 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10670 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10671
10672 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10673
10674 @enumerate
10675 @item
10676 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10677 @example
10678 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10679 @end example
10680 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10681
10682 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10683 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10684 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10685
10686 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10687 remote command above that becomes:
10688 @example
10689 tar ext :3333
10690 @end example
10691
10692 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10693 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10694 available through the command:
10695 @example
10696 target remote localhost:3333
10697 @end example
10698
10699 @item
10700 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10701 @example
10702 target extended-remote | \
10703 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10704 @end example
10705 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10706 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10707 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10708 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10709 @end enumerate
10710
10711 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10712 GDB command line.
10713
10714 @section Sample GDB session startup
10715
10716 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10717 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10718 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10719 small ARM program.
10720 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10721 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10722
10723 @example
10724 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10725 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10726 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10727 ...
10728 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10729 ...
10730 (gdb) load
10731 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10732 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10733 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10734 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10735 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10736 (gdb) continue
10737 Continuing.
10738 ...
10739 @end example
10740
10741 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10742 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10743 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10744 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10745
10746 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10747
10748 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10749 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10750 packet size and the device's memory map.
10751 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10752 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10753 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10754
10755 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10756 You may need to set those up by hand.
10757 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10758 something like:
10759
10760 @example
10761 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10762 @end example
10763
10764 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10765
10766 @example
10767 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10768 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10769 @end example
10770
10771 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10772 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10773 do not have such restrictions.
10774
10775 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10776 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10777 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10778 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10779
10780 @section Programming using GDB
10781 @cindex Programming using GDB
10782 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10783
10784 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10785 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10786 @example
10787 gdb_memory_map disable
10788 @end example
10789 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10790 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10791 working area.
10792
10793 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10794 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10795 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10796 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10797
10798 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10799 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10800
10801 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10802 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10803 @example
10804 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10805 @end example
10806
10807 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10808 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10809
10810 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10811 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10812 will be used.
10813
10814 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10815 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10816 @example
10817 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10818 @end example
10819 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10820
10821 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10822 can be used.
10823
10824 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10825 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10826 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10827
10828 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10829 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10830 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10831
10832 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10833 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10834 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10835 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10836 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10837 without any intrusion of the target process.
10838
10839 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10840 Place following command after target configuration:
10841 @example
10842 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10843 @end example
10844
10845 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10846 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10847 @example
10848 gdb_memory_map disable
10849 @end example
10850
10851 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10852 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10853 @example
10854 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10855 @end example
10856
10857 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10858 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10859
10860 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10861 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10862 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10863 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10864
10865 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10866 previously shown variables.
10867
10868 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10869 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10870 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10871 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10872 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10873
10874 @section RTOS Support
10875 @cindex RTOS Support
10876 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10877
10878 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10879 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10880
10881 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10882 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10883 GDB commands.
10884
10885 @* An example setup is below:
10886
10887 @example
10888 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10889 @end example
10890
10891 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10892
10893 Currently supported rtos's include:
10894 @itemize @bullet
10895 @item @option{eCos}
10896 @item @option{ThreadX}
10897 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10898 @item @option{linux}
10899 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10900 @item @option{embKernel}
10901 @item @option{mqx}
10902 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10903 @item @option{nuttx}
10904 @item @option{RIOT}
10905 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10906 @end itemize
10907
10908 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10909 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10910
10911 @table @code
10912 @item eCos symbols
10913 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10914 @item ThreadX symbols
10915 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10916 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10917 @raggedright
10918 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10919 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10920 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10921 @end raggedright
10922 @item linux symbols
10923 init_task.
10924 @item ChibiOS symbols
10925 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10926 @item embKernel symbols
10927 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10928 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10929 @item mqx symbols
10930 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10931 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10932 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
10933 @item nuttx symbols
10934 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
10935 @item RIOT symbols
10936 @raggedright
10937 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
10938 _tcb_name_offset.
10939 @end raggedright
10940 @end table
10941
10942 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10943 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10944
10945 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10946 along with the project:
10947
10948 @table @code
10949 @item FreeRTOS
10950 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10951 @item uC/OS-III
10952 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10953 @end table
10954
10955 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10956 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10957 @cindex SMP
10958 @cindex RTOS
10959 @cindex hwthread
10960 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10961 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10962 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10963 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10964 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10965 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10966 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10967 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10968 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10969
10970 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10971 @quotation Note
10972 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10973 @end quotation
10974
10975 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10976 @itemize @bullet
10977 @item j - smp status request
10978 @item J - smp set request
10979 @end itemize
10980
10981 OpenOCD implements :
10982 @itemize @bullet
10983 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10984 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10985 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10986 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10987 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10988 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10989 @end itemize
10990
10991 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10992 @itemize @bullet
10993 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10994 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10995 @example
10996 set $_core 1
10997 #Jc01 packet is sent
10998 print $_core
10999 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11000 @end example
11001
11002 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11003 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11004
11005 @example
11006 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11007 define toggle0
11008 maint packet Jc0
11009 continue
11010 main packet Jc-1
11011 end
11012 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11013 define toggle1
11014 maint packet Jc1
11015 continue
11016 main packet Jc-1
11017 end
11018 @end example
11019 @end itemize
11020
11021 @node Tcl Scripting API
11022 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11023 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11024 @cindex Tcl scripts
11025 @section API rules
11026
11027 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11028 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11029 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11030
11031 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11032 pair list and lists.
11033
11034 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11035 list.
11036
11037 @example
11038 > set foo(me) Duane
11039 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11040 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11041 > set foo(duck) Donald
11042 @end example
11043
11044 If one does this:
11045
11046 @example
11047 > set foo
11048 @end example
11049
11050 The result is:
11051
11052 @example
11053 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11054 @end example
11055
11056 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11057
11058 @verbatim
11059 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11060 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11061 }
11062 @end verbatim
11063
11064 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11065 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11066
11067 @section Internal low-level Commands
11068
11069 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
11070 invoke directly.
11071
11072 @itemize @bullet
11073 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11074
11075 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11076 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11077
11078 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11079 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11080
11081 Return information about the flash banks
11082
11083 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11084
11085 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11086 its execution. Example:
11087
11088 @example
11089 > capture "reset init"
11090 @end example
11091
11092 @end itemize
11093
11094 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11095 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11096 called "flash_banks".
11097
11098 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
11099
11100 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
11101 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
11102 holds one of the following values:
11103
11104 @itemize @bullet
11105 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
11106 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
11107 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
11108 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
11109 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
11110 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
11111 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
11112 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
11113 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
11114 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
11115 @end itemize
11116
11117 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
11118
11119 @quotation Note
11120 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
11121 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
11122 @code{jim_platform} (because it
11123 is jim, not real tcl).
11124 @end quotation
11125
11126 @section Tcl RPC server
11127 @cindex RPC
11128
11129 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11130 commands and receive the results.
11131
11132 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11133 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11134 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11135 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11136 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11137
11138 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11139 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11140 @command{capture} command.
11141
11142 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11143
11144 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11145 @cindex RPC Notifications
11146
11147 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11148 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11149
11150 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11151 in the following format.
11152
11153 @verbatim
11154 type target_event event [event-name]
11155 type target_state state [state-name]
11156 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11157 @end verbatim
11158
11159 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
11160 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11161 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11162 Defaults to off.
11163
11164 @end deffn
11165
11166 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11167 @cindex RPC trace output
11168
11169 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11170 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11171
11172 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11173
11174 @verbatim
11175 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11176 @end verbatim
11177
11178 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
11179 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11180 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11181 Defaults to off.
11182
11183 See an example application here:
11184 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11185
11186 @end deffn
11187
11188 @node FAQ
11189 @chapter FAQ
11190 @cindex faq
11191 @enumerate
11192 @anchor{faqrtck}
11193 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11194 @cindex RTCK
11195 @cindex adaptive clocking
11196 @*
11197
11198 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11199 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11200 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11201 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11202
11203 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11204 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11205 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11206 @enumerate
11207 @item
11208 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11209 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11210 @item
11211 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11212 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11213 @end enumerate
11214
11215 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11216 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11217 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11218 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11219 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11220 power).
11221
11222 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11223 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11224 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11225 ARM926 scenario).
11226 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11227 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11228 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11229
11230 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11231 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11232 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11233 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11234
11235 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11236
11237 In order to make use of this,
11238 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11239 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11240
11241 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11242 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11243 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11244 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11245 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11246
11247 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11248 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11249 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11250 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11251
11252 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11253 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11254 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11255 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11256 with a CPLD.
11257 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11258 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11259 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11260 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11261 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11262 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11263
11264 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11265
11266 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11267
11268 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11269 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11270 depending on the chips on your board.
11271 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11272 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11273 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11274
11275 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11276 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11277 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11278
11279 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11280 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11281 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11282 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11283
11284 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11285 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11286 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11287 this way.
11288
11289 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11290 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11291 clock rate.
11292 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11293 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11294 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11295
11296 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11297
11298 @example
11299 # Example: 1.234MHz
11300 adapter speed 1234
11301 @end example
11302
11303
11304 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11305
11306 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11307 around Windows filenames.
11308
11309 @example
11310 > echo \a
11311
11312 > echo @{\a@}
11313 \a
11314 > echo "\a"
11315
11316 >
11317 @end example
11318
11319
11320 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11321
11322 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11323 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11324 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11325
11326 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11327 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11328 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11329
11330 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11331 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11332 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11333
11334 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11335
11336 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11337 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11338 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11339 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11340
11341 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11342 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11343 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11344
11345 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11346 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11347
11348 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11349 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11350 memory read caused data abort".
11351
11352 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11353 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11354 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11355 be done, feel free to add this here.
11356
11357 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11358 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11359 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11360 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11361 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11362 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11363 gracefully stops.
11364
11365 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11366 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11367 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11368
11369 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11370 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11371 bytes. Painful...
11372
11373
11374 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11375 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11376
11377 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11378 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11379 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11380 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11381 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11382 reset, everything else should work fine.
11383
11384 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11385 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11386 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11387 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11388
11389 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11390 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11391 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11392 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11393
11394 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11395
11396 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11397 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11398 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11399
11400 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11401 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11402
11403 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11404 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11405 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11406 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11407 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11408 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11409 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11410 clock frequency?
11411
11412 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11413 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11414 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11415 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11416 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11417
11418 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11419
11420 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11421 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11422 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11423 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11424 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11425 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11426 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11427
11428 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11429
11430 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11431 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11432 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11433 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11434
11435 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11436 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11437 particular order?
11438
11439 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11440 the same order used by the hardware.
11441
11442 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11443 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11444 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11445 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11446 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11447 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11448
11449 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11450 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11451 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11452 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11453
11454 @itemize @bullet
11455 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11456 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11457 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11458 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11459 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11460 @end itemize
11461
11462 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11463
11464 @itemize @bullet
11465 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11466 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11467 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11468 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11469 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11470 @end itemize
11471
11472
11473 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11474 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11475 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11476
11477 TODO.
11478
11479 @end enumerate
11480
11481 @node Tcl Crash Course
11482 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11483 @cindex Tcl
11484
11485 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11486 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11487 how the Tcl scripts work.
11488
11489 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11490 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11491 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11492 OpenOCD.
11493
11494 @section Tcl Rule #1
11495 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11496 @enumerate
11497 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11498 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11499 @end enumerate
11500
11501 The Tcl equal is this:
11502
11503 @enumerate
11504 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11505 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11506 @end enumerate
11507
11508 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11509 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11510
11511 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11512 There is a second pair of rules.
11513 @enumerate
11514 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11515 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11516 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11517 in Tcl.
11518 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11519 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11520 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11521 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11522 @end enumerate
11523
11524 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11525 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11526 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11527 Everything is a string}
11528
11529 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11530 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11531 difference is subtle.
11532 @enumerate
11533 @item Parse Time
11534 @item Evaluation Time
11535 @end enumerate
11536
11537 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11538 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11539 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11540
11541 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11542 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11543 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11544 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11545
11546 @itemize @bullet
11547 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11548 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11549 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11550 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11551 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11552 @example
11553 # bash example
11554 X=`date`
11555 echo "The Date is: $X"
11556 # Tcl example
11557 set X [date]
11558 puts "The Date is: $X"
11559 @end example
11560 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11561 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11562 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11563 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11564 is a string}
11565 @example
11566 set x "Dinner"
11567 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11568 @end example
11569 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11570 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11571 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11572 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11573 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11574 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11575 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11576 @end itemize
11577
11578 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11579
11580 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11581
11582 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11583
11584 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11585 the normal way.
11586
11587 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11588 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11589 line is immediately executed.
11590
11591 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11592 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11593
11594 @subsection Command Execution
11595
11596 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11597 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11598 control flow operators.
11599
11600 Commands are executed like this:
11601
11602 @enumerate
11603 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11604 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11605 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11606 @end enumerate
11607
11608 It sort of works like this:
11609 @example
11610 for(;;)@{
11611 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11612
11613 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11614
11615 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11616 @}
11617 @end example
11618
11619 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11620 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11621 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11622 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11623 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11624 ``LookupCommand()''
11625
11626 @subsection The FOR command
11627
11628 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11629 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11630 command just like any other command.
11631
11632 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11633 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11634 are:
11635
11636 @enumerate 0
11637 @item The ascii text 'for'
11638 @item The start text
11639 @item The test expression
11640 @item The next text
11641 @item The body text
11642 @end enumerate
11643
11644 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11645 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11646 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11647 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11648
11649 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11650 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11651
11652 @example
11653 int
11654 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11655 int *argc,
11656 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11657 @end example
11658
11659 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11660 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11661 still operates in the same basic way.
11662
11663 @subsection FOR command implementation
11664
11665 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11666 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11667
11668 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11669
11670 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11671
11672 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11673 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11674 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11675
11676 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11677 expression and returns a value.
11678
11679 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11680 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11681 @example
11682 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11683
11684 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11685
11686 int
11687 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11688 int argc,
11689 char **argv )
11690 @{
11691 if( argc != 5 )@{
11692 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11693 return ERROR;
11694 @}
11695
11696 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11697
11698 // Execute the start statement.
11699 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11700
11701 // Top of loop test
11702 for(;;)@{
11703 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11704 if( i == 0 )
11705 break;
11706
11707 // Execute the body
11708 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11709
11710 // Execute the LOOP part
11711 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11712 @}
11713
11714 // Return no error
11715 SetResult( interp, "" );
11716 return SUCCESS;
11717 @}
11718 @end example
11719
11720 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11721 in the same basic way.
11722
11723 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11724
11725 @subsection source and find commands
11726 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11727 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11728 @*Remember the parsing rules
11729 @enumerate
11730 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11731 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11732 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11733 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11734 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11735 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11736 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11737 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11738 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11739 @end enumerate
11740 @subsection format command
11741 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11742 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11743 @b{sprintf()}.
11744 @b{Example}
11745 @example
11746 set x 6
11747 set y 7
11748 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11749 @end example
11750 @enumerate
11751 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11752 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11753 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11754 @* Refer to Rule #1
11755 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11756 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11757 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11758 @end enumerate
11759 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11760 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11761 @example
11762 #1 Good
11763 proc someproc @{@} @{
11764 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11765 @}
11766 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11767 #2 Good - no variables
11768 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11769 #3 Good Curly Braces
11770 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11771 puts "Time: [date]"
11772 @}
11773 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11774 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11775 @end example
11776 @enumerate
11777 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11778 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11779 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11780 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11781 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11782 command.
11783 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11784 @*There are 4 examples:
11785 @enumerate
11786 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11787 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11788 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11789 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11790 @end enumerate
11791
11792 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11793 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11794 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11795
11796 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11797 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11798 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11799 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11800 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11801 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11802 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11803 @end enumerate
11804 @subsection Global Variables
11805 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11806 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11807 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11808 @example
11809 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11810 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11811 global x #Global variable X
11812 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11813 @}
11814 @end example
11815 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11816 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11817 @example
11818 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11819 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11820 # Create var name
11821 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11822 # Make it a global
11823 global $vn
11824 # Set it.
11825 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11826 @}
11827 @end example
11828 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11829 @example
11830 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11831 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11832 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11833 @}
11834 @end example
11835
11836 @node License
11837 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
11838 @include fdl.texi
11839
11840 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11841 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11842 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11843 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11844 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11845 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11846
11847 @printindex cp
11848
11849 @node Command and Driver Index
11850 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11851 @printindex fn
11852
11853 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)